]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
Update the documentation of the LINKER_VERSIOn script command to actually mention...
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
d87bef3a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
d87bef3a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c 87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
3ac23310 88\hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
d87bef3a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
2d5783fa
NC
464@kindex --enable-linker-version
465@item --enable-linker-version
466Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475@kindex --disable-linker-version
476@item --disable-linker-version
477Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
abf874aa
CL
480@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490@smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
93cda40b
NC
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
abf874aa
CL
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
94ffdb59 499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
abf874aa
CL
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509@end smallexample
510
511This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516This option enables warnings when
517@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520output region.
521
252b5132
RH
522@cindex entry point, from command line
523@kindex -e @var{entry}
524@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 525@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
526@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
b58f81ae
DJ
535@kindex --exclude-libs
536@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 538exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
539@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544be treated as hidden.
545
e1c37eb5
DK
546@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557regardless of this option.
558
252b5132
RH
559@cindex dynamic symbol table
560@kindex -E
561@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 562@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
563@item -E
564@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
565@itemx --no-export-dynamic
566When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
575
576If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579linking the program itself.
580
55255dae 581You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 582be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 583See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 584
8b747e1a
DK
585Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
37a141bf
FS
589@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590@cindex export dynamic symbol
591@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601@cindex export dynamic symbol list
602@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
36f63dca 607@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
608@cindex big-endian objects
609@cindex endianness
610@kindex -EB
611@item -EB
612Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614@cindex little-endian objects
615@kindex -EL
616@item -EL
617Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 618@end ifclear
252b5132 619
2509a395
SL
620@kindex -f @var{name}
621@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622@item -f @var{name}
623@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
624When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 637machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
638
639This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
2509a395
SL
642@kindex -F @var{name}
643@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 644@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 645@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
646When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657@var{name}.
658
ff5dcc92 659Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 660toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
661object files.
662@ifclear SingleFormat
663The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 664@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 665@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
666environment variable.
667@end ifclear
668The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 670
3dbf70a2 671@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
672@kindex -fini=@var{name}
673@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
674When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677the function to call.
678
252b5132
RH
679@kindex -g
680@item -g
681Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
2509a395
SL
683@kindex -G @var{value}
684@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 685@cindex object size
2509a395 686@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
687@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 690MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
691sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 694@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 695@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 696@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
697@itemx -soname=@var{name}
698When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 702field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
703
704@kindex -i
705@cindex incremental link
706@item -i
707Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
3dbf70a2 709@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
710@kindex -init=@var{name}
711@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
712When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715function to call.
716
252b5132 717@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 718@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 719@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 720@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
721@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 725will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 726will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 727
ff5dcc92 728On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
729files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
736
737The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
ff5dcc92 744See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
745archives multiple times.
746
747You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749@ifset GENERIC
750This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 751if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
752behaviour of the AIX linker.
753@end ifset
754
755@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 756@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 757@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 758@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 759@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
760Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
762option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 765@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
766order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768option is specified.
252b5132 769
3aa2d05a
NC
770If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 773
252b5132
RH
774@ifset UsesEnvVars
775The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 776@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
777some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778@end ifset
779
780The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784@cindex emulation
785@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 786@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
787Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794configured.
795
fb221fba
NC
796@cindex remapping inputs
797@kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798@kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799@item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800@itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802linker attempts to open them. The option
803@option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805@file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809An alternative form of the option
810@option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826from a complicated build environment.
827
828Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831@smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833@end smallexample
834
835Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837@smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839@end smallexample
840
841Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846options on the command line is not significant.
847
848If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851appear.
852
853If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
252b5132
RH
856@cindex link map
857@kindex -M
858@kindex --print-map
859@item -M
860@itemx --print-map
861Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862information about the link, including the following:
863
864@itemize @bullet
865@item
3b83e13a 866Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
867@item
868How common symbols are allocated.
869@item
870All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
872@item
873The values assigned to symbols.
874
875Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881linker script containing:
882
883@smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887@end smallexample
888
889will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890option is used:
891
892@smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896@end smallexample
897
898See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899scripts.
d2ef37eb 900
06ddcada
AM
901@item
902How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 903
06ddcada
AM
904When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
907
908@smallexample
909Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910@end smallexample
911
06ddcada 912This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
913merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916@smallexample
06ddcada 917Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
918@end smallexample
919
06ddcada 920This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
921when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
923@end itemize
924
035801ce
FS
925@cindex link map discarded
926@kindex --print-map-discarded
927@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
928@item --print-map-discarded
929@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
930Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
931in the link map. Enabled by default.
932
496917ce
NC
933@kindex --print-map-locals
934@kindex --no-print-map-locals
935@item --print-map-locals
936@itemx --no-print-map-locals
937Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
938will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
939be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
940Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
941will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
942
252b5132
RH
943@kindex -n
944@cindex read-only text
945@cindex NMAGIC
946@kindex --nmagic
947@item -n
948@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
949Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
950libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
951mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
952
953@kindex -N
954@kindex --omagic
955@cindex read/write from cmd line
956@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 957@item -N
252b5132
RH
958@itemx --omagic
959Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
960not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
961libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
962mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
963is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
964specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
965
966@kindex --no-omagic
967@cindex OMAGIC
968@item --no-omagic
969This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
970sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
971be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
972shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
973
974@kindex -o @var{output}
975@kindex --output=@var{output}
976@cindex naming the output file
977@item -o @var{output}
978@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 979Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
980option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
981script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
982
f37b21b4
RM
983@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
984@cindex dependency file
985@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
986Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
987suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
988that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
989output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
990Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
991Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
992to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
993linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
994@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
995installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
996distributed makefiles without careful editing.
997
252b5132
RH
998@kindex -O @var{level}
999@cindex generating optimized output
1000@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 1001If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 1002the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
1003should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1004option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1005the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1006no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1007of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 1008
387dd777
DP
1009@kindex -plugin @var{name}
1010@item -plugin @var{name}
1011Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1012the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1013automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1014optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1015wish.
1016
1017Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1018from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1019@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1020those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 1021copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 1022based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 1023just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 1024
26278bb8
UD
1025@kindex --push-state
1026@cindex push state governing input file handling
1027@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 1028The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
1029flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1030restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1031
1032The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1033@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1034@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1035@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1036@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1037@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1038
1039One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1040used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1041listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1042something as follows:
1043
1044@smallexample
1045-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1046@end smallexample
1047
1048@kindex --pop-state
1049@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 1050@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
1051Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1052flags governing input file handling.
1053
a712da20
NC
1054@kindex -q
1055@kindex --emit-relocs
1056@cindex retain relocations in final executable
1057@item -q
1058@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 1059Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
1060Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1061order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1062in larger executables.
1063
dbab7a7b
NC
1064This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1065
4f471f39
RS
1066@kindex --force-dynamic
1067@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1068@item --force-dynamic
1069Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1070to VxWorks targets.
1071
252b5132
RH
1072@cindex partial link
1073@cindex relocatable output
1074@kindex -r
1049f94e 1075@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 1076@item -r
1049f94e 1077@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 1078Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1079turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
1080linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1081magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1082@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 1083@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
1084If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1085linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1086constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1087
62bf86b4
HPN
1088When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1089partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1090relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1091example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1092with input files in other formats at all.
1093
252b5132
RH
1094This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1095
1096@kindex -R @var{file}
1097@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1098@cindex symbol-only input
1099@item -R @var{filename}
1100@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1101Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1102relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1103to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1104programs. You may use this option more than once.
1105
ff5dcc92 1106For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1107followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1108the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1109
1110@kindex -s
1111@kindex --strip-all
1112@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -s
252b5132
RH
1114@itemx --strip-all
1115Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1116
1117@kindex -S
1118@kindex --strip-debug
1119@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1120@item -S
252b5132
RH
1121@itemx --strip-debug
1122Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1123
a70f34c0
NC
1124@kindex --strip-discarded
1125@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1126@item --strip-discarded
1127@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1128Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1129Enabled by default.
1130
252b5132
RH
1131@kindex -t
1132@kindex --trace
1133@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1134@item -t
252b5132 1135@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1136Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1137@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1138@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1139and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1140a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1141
1142@kindex -T @var{script}
1143@kindex --script=@var{script}
1144@cindex script files
1145@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1146@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1147Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
31f14901
AM
1148@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1149unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
252b5132 1150@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1151output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1152the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1153specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1154options accumulate.
252b5132 1155
14be8564
L
1156@kindex -dT @var{script}
1157@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1158@cindex script files
1159@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1160@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1161Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1162
1163This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1164processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1165command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1166@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1167behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1168command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1169the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1170@samp{gcc}).
1171
252b5132
RH
1172@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1173@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1174@cindex undefined symbol
1175@item -u @var{symbol}
1176@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1177Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1178symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1179modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1180different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1181option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1182
0a618243
AB
1183If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1184into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1185undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1186instead.
1187
1188@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1189@cindex symbols, require defined
1190@cindex defined symbol
1191@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1192Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1193is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1194is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1195and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1196@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1197can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1198
252b5132
RH
1199@kindex -Ur
1200@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1201@item -Ur
0a7dda4f
NC
1202
1203For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1204based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1205relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1206input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1207option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1208constructors and destructors.
1209
35f8b059
NC
1210For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1211differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1212themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1213been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1214partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
252b5132 1215
c005eb9e
AB
1216@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1217@cindex orphan sections
1218@cindex sections, orphan
1219@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1220Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1221specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1222
1223@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1224
1225@table @code
1226@item place
1227Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1228the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1229@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1230
1231@item discard
1232All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1233@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1234
1235@item warn
1236The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1237issue a warning.
1238
1239@item error
1240The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1241@end table
1242
1243The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1244
577a0623
AM
1245@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1246@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1247Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1248@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1249missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1250specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1251multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1252input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1253in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1254
252b5132
RH
1255@kindex -v
1256@kindex -V
1257@kindex --version
1258@cindex version
1259@item -v
1260@itemx --version
1261@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1262Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
2d5783fa
NC
1263lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1264@option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1265which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
252b5132
RH
1266
1267@kindex -x
1268@kindex --discard-all
1269@cindex deleting local symbols
1270@item -x
1271@itemx --discard-all
1272Delete all local symbols.
1273
1274@kindex -X
1275@kindex --discard-locals
1276@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1277@item -X
252b5132 1278@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1279Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1280system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1281or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1282
1283@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1284@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1285@cindex symbol tracing
1286@item -y @var{symbol}
1287@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1288Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1289option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1290to prepend an underscore.
1291
1292This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1293don't know where the reference is coming from.
1294
1295@kindex -Y @var{path}
1296@item -Y @var{path}
1297Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1298for Solaris compatibility.
1299
1300@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1301@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1302The recognized keywords are:
1303@table @samp
1304
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1306@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1307@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1308@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1309Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1310to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1311@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1312@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1313@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1314@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1315Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1316
233a0083
L
1317@item cet-report=none
1318@itemx cet-report=warning
1319@itemx cet-report=error
1320Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1321GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1322section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1323linker not report missing properties in input files.
1324@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1325missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1326the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1327Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1328GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1329turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1330Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1331
cd6d6c15 1332@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1333@itemx nocombreloc
1334Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1335dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1336
b8871f35 1337@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1338@itemx nocommon
1339Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1340link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1341
1342@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1343Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1344layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1345using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1346
cd6d6c15 1347@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1348Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1349is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1350This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1351
e6e2dfbd
AM
1352@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1353@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1354Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1355if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1356by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1357@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1358may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1359selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1360these options.
1361
6aa29e7b
JJ
1362@item execstack
1363Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1364
b039ef04
L
1365@item global
1366This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1367the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1368of subsequently loaded libraries.
1369
93ab9c0d
NC
1370@item globalaudit
1371This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1372This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1373setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1374tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1375the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1376all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1377
e6e2dfbd
AM
1378@item ibtplt
1379Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1380Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1381
8df93cb5 1382@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1384to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1385Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1386
6f365fda
L
1387@item indirect-extern-access
1388@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1389Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1390.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1391canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1392This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1393@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1394
1395@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1396GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1397section.
1398
cd6d6c15
NC
1399@item initfirst
1400This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1401It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1402before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1403the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1404the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1405objects.
1406
1407@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1408Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1409so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1410libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1411
c3805e4c
VDM
1412@item unique
1413@itemx nounique
1414When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1415object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1416and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1417primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1418al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1419of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1420and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1421
279d901e
L
1422@item lam-u48
1423Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1424to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1425
1426@item lam-u57
1427Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1428to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1429
1430@item lam-u48-report=none
1431@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1432@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1433Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1434property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1435@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1436linker not report missing properties in input files.
1437@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1438missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1439make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1440Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1441
1442@item lam-u57-report=none
1443@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1444@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1445Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1446property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1447@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1448linker not report missing properties in input files.
1449@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1450missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1451make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1452Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1453
1454@item lam-report=none
1455@itemx lam-report=warning
1456@itemx lam-report=error
1457Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1458GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1459section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1460linker not report missing properties in input files.
1461@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1462missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1463the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1464Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1465
5fa222e4
AM
1466@item lazy
1467When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1468dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1469the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1470Lazy binding is the default.
1471
cd6d6c15 1472@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1473Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1474
e6e2dfbd
AM
1475@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1476Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1477
832ca732
L
1478@item mark-plt
1479@itemx nomark-plt
1480Mark PLT entries with dynamic tags, DT_X86_64_PLT, DT_X86_64_PLTSZ and
1481DT_X86_64_PLTENT. Since this option stores a non-zero value in the
1482r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, the resulting
1483executables and shared libraries are incompatible with dynamic linkers,
1484such as those in older versions of glibc without the change to ignore
1485r_addend in R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT and R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, which
1486don't ignore the r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations.
1487Supported for x86_64.
1488
e6e2dfbd
AM
1489@item muldefs
1490Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1491
cd6d6c15 1492@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1493Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1494defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1495
1496@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1497Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1498should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1499
1500@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1501Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1502
1503@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1504Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1505
1506@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1507Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1508
6aa29e7b
JJ
1509@item noexecstack
1510Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1511
e6e2dfbd
AM
1512@item noextern-protected-data
1513Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1514library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1515used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1516generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1517module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1518i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1519
e6e2dfbd
AM
1520@item noreloc-overflow
1521Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1522relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1523overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1524
cd6d6c15
NC
1525@item now
1526When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1527dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1528when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1529function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1530called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1531
1532@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1533Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1534
6a91be86
L
1535@item pack-relative-relocs
1536@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1537Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1538and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1539@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1540building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1541@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1542relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1543GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1544added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1545
6aa29e7b 1546@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1547@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1548Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1549specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1550relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1551than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1552Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1553
68b00778
L
1554@item report-relative-reloc
1555Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1556Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1557
96cc7918
KB
1558@item sectionheader
1559@itemx nosectionheader
1560Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1561@samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1562
47acac12
L
1563@item separate-code
1564@itemx noseparate-code
1565Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1566specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1567be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1568code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1569
e6e2dfbd
AM
1570@item shstk
1571Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1572to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1573Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1574
04c3a755 1575@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1576Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1577Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1578@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1579
8ee10e86
AM
1580@item start-stop-gc
1581@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1582@cindex start-stop-gc
1583When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1584section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1585input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1586@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1587@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1588linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1589sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1590were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1591definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1592object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1593linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1594@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1595treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1596
cae64165
RM
1597@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1598@cindex visibility
1599@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1600Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1601@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1602Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1603@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1604start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1605compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1606recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1607programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1608between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1609
e6e2dfbd
AM
1610@item text
1611@itemx notext
1612@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1613Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1614or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1615report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1616
97a232d7
NC
1617@item undefs
1618Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1619either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1620This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1621
2d95647b
L
1622@item unique-symbol
1623@itemx nounique-symbol
1624Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1625".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1626is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1627
b0ab0693 1628@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1629@item x86-64-v2
1630@item x86-64-v3
1631@itemx x86-64-v4
1632Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1633@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1634@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1635@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1636@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1637Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1638
cd6d6c15
NC
1639@end table
1640
ece2d90e 1641Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1642
1643@kindex -(
1644@cindex groups of archives
1645@item -( @var{archives} -)
1646@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1647The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1648either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1649
1650The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1651references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1652the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1653archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1654object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1655would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1656they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1657resolved.
1658
1659Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1660it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1661more archives.
1662
69da35b5
NC
1663@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1664@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1665@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1666@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1667Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1668recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1669and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1670the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1671behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1672so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1673restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1674
4a43e768
AM
1675@kindex --as-needed
1676@kindex --no-as-needed
1677@item --as-needed
1678@itemx --no-as-needed
1679This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1680on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1681the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1682on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1683needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1684emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1685non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1686the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1687non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1688Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1689the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1690needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1691from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1692
6418520e
NC
1693Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1694an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1695@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1696@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1697
e56f61be
L
1698@kindex --add-needed
1699@kindex --no-add-needed
1700@item --add-needed
1701@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1702These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1703their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1704options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1705and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1706
252b5132
RH
1707@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1708@item -assert @var{keyword}
1709This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1710
1711@kindex -Bdynamic
1712@kindex -dy
1713@kindex -call_shared
1714@item -Bdynamic
1715@itemx -dy
1716@itemx -call_shared
1717Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1718for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1719default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1720for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1721multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1722@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1723
a1ab1d2a
UD
1724@kindex -Bgroup
1725@item -Bgroup
1726Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1727section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1728object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1729@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1730only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1731
252b5132
RH
1732@kindex -Bstatic
1733@kindex -dn
1734@kindex -non_shared
1735@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1736@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1737@itemx -dn
1738@itemx -non_shared
1739@itemx -static
1740Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1741platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1742variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1743may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1744library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1745option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1746option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1747shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1748references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1749libraries.
252b5132
RH
1750
1751@kindex -Bsymbolic
1752@item -Bsymbolic
1753When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1754definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1755for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1756within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1757platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1758
40b36307
L
1759@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1760@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1761When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1762symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1763This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1764libraries.
40b36307 1765
cf893b0e
FS
1766@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1767@item -Bno-symbolic
1768This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1769@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1770
55255dae
L
1771@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1772@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1773Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1774typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1775global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1776within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1777to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1778in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1779which support shared libraries.
1780
1781The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1782scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1783
40b36307
L
1784@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1785@item --dynamic-list-data
1786Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1787
1788@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1789@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1790Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1791is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1792
0b8a70d9
L
1793@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1794@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1795Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1796
252b5132
RH
1797@kindex --check-sections
1798@kindex --no-check-sections
1799@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1800@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1801Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1802been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1803perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1804suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1805allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1806restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1807Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1808force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1809option.
252b5132 1810
ddbb8a31
NC
1811@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1812@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1813@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1814@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1815This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1816by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1817command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1818output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1819input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1820specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1821follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1822behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1823
1824This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1825libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1826mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1827their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1828required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1829the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1830dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1831symbols.
1832
252b5132
RH
1833@cindex cross reference table
1834@kindex --cref
1835@item --cref
1836Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1837generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1838Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1839
1840The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1841easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1842sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1843symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1844definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1845where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1846symbol are listed.
252b5132 1847
5dba6f05
NA
1848@cindex ctf variables
1849@kindex --ctf-variables
1850@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1851@item --ctf-variables
1852@item --no-ctf-variables
1853The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1854types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1855table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1856conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1857usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1858@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1859The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1860
1861@cindex ctf type sharing
1862@kindex --ctf-share-types
1863@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1864Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1865
1866@table @samp
1867@item share-unconflicted
1868Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1869where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1870translation unit. This is the default.
1871
1872@item share-duplicated
1873Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1874dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1875dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1876always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1877larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1878large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1879consumer at runtime.
1880@end table
1881
4818e05f
AM
1882@cindex common allocation
1883@kindex --no-define-common
1884@item --no-define-common
1885This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1886The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1887@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1888
1889The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1890the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1891of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1892forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1893Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1894from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1895This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1896and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1897duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1898paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1899
7bdf4127
AB
1900@cindex group allocation in linker script
1901@cindex section groups
1902@cindex COMDAT
1903@kindex --force-group-allocation
1904@item --force-group-allocation
1905This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1906normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1907default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1908change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1909command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1910effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1911
252b5132 1912@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1913@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1914@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1915Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1916address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1917times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1918limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1919context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1920symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1921constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1922using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1923@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1924equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1925
54874444
AB
1926The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1927in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1928symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1929placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1930the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1931consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1932@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1933you are trying to achieve.
1934
252b5132 1935@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1936@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1937@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1938@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1939@itemx --no-demangle
1940These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1941and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1942present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1943underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1944mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1945different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1946to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1947demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1948is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1949
1950@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1951@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1952@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1953@item -I@var{file}
1954@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1955Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1956generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1957linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1958doing.
1959
9b8b325a
RF
1960@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1961@item --no-dynamic-linker
1962When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1963linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1964executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1965entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1966
a70f34c0
NC
1967@kindex --embedded-relocs
1968@item --embedded-relocs
1969This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1970that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1971is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1972targets.
1973
3f0a5f17
ME
1974@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1975@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1976Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1977in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1978
7ce691ae 1979@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1980@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1981@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1982@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1983Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1984with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1985
4b2e7a57
NC
1986@kindex -w
1987@kindex --no-warnings
1988@item -w
1989@itemx --no-warnings
1990Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1991@option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1992used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1993is still a need to create it.
1994
252b5132
RH
1995@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1996@item --force-exe-suffix
1997Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1998
1999If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
2000@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
2001the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
2002option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
2003Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
2004it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
2005
2006@kindex --gc-sections
2007@kindex --no-gc-sections
2008@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
2009@item --gc-sections
2010@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 2011Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 2012targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 2013performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
2014@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2015collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2016implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 2017
d5465ba2
AM
2018@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2019examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2020symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2021command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2022referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2023libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2024referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2025the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
2026relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2027@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 2028
ac69cbc6 2029This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 2030@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
2031specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2032@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2033command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 2034
99fabbc9
JL
2035As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2036@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2037
c17d87de
NC
2038@kindex --print-gc-sections
2039@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2040@cindex garbage collection
2041@item --print-gc-sections
2042@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2043List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2044printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2045collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2046default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2047be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2048line.
2049
22185505 2050@kindex --gc-keep-exported
2051@cindex garbage collection
2052@item --gc-keep-exported
2053When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2054collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2055default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2056executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2057collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2058Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2059it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2060ELF format targets.
2061
30824704
RM
2062@kindex --print-output-format
2063@cindex output format
2064@item --print-output-format
2065Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2066other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2067in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2068
3604cb1f
TG
2069@kindex --print-memory-usage
2070@cindex memory usage
2071@item --print-memory-usage
2072Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2073the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2074quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2075headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2076parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2077
2078@smallexample
2079Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2080 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2081 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2082@end smallexample
2083
252b5132
RH
2084@cindex help
2085@cindex usage
2086@kindex --help
2087@item --help
2088Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2089
ea20a7da
CC
2090@kindex --target-help
2091@item --target-help
a094d01f 2092Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 2093
2509a395
SL
2094@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2095@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 2096Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
2097@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2098@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2099
2100Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2101written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2102inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2103file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2104@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2105output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2106@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2107
2108@smallexample
2109 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2110 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2111 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2112 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2113 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2114 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2115 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2116 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2117 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2118 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2119@end smallexample
2120
2121It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2122
2123If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2124operation.
252b5132
RH
2125
2126@cindex memory usage
2127@kindex --no-keep-memory
2128@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2129@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2130symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2131instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2132necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2133while linking a large executable.
2134
2135@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2136@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2137@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2138@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2139@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2140Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2141is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2142The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2143behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2144libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2145
97a232d7
NC
2146The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2147
aa713662
L
2148@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2149@kindex -z muldefs
2150@item --allow-multiple-definition
2151@itemx -z muldefs
2152Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2153report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2154first definition will be used.
2155
b79e8c78 2156@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2157@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2158@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2159@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2160Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2161This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2162determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2163shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2164how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2165
903249d7
NC
2166The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2167referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2168an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2169a shared library.
2170
2171The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2172libraries specified at link time are that:
2173
2174@itemize @bullet
2175@item
2176A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2177that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2178resolvable at load time.
2179@item
2180There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2181symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2182
2183The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2184select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2185architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2186appropriate memset function.
2187@end itemize
b79e8c78 2188
23ae20f5
NC
2189@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2190@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2191If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2192@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2193only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2194libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
5c14cc55 2195``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
93cf38c0
NC
2196undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2197will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2198might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2199error message will be displayed.
2200
2201The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2202switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2203
31941635
L
2204@kindex --no-undefined-version
2205@item --no-undefined-version
2206Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2207it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2208will be issued instead.
2209
3e3b46e5
PB
2210@kindex --default-symver
2211@item --default-symver
2212Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2213exported symbols.
2214
2215@kindex --default-imported-symver
2216@item --default-imported-symver
2217Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2218imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2219
252b5132
RH
2220@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2221@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2222Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2223files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2224been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2225This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2226errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2227have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2228inappropriate.
2229
fe7929ce
AM
2230@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2231@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2232Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2233library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2234
252b5132
RH
2235@kindex --no-whole-archive
2236@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2237Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2238archive files.
2239
2240@cindex output file after errors
2241@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2242@item --noinhibit-exec
2243Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2244Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2245errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2246when it issues any error whatsoever.
2247
0a9c1c8e
CD
2248@kindex -nostdlib
2249@item -nostdlib
2250Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2251command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2252(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2253
252b5132 2254@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2255@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2256@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2257@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2258file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2259@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2260object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2261object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2262should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2263usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2264name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2265list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2266command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2267this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2268@end ifclear
2269
76359541
TP
2270@kindex --out-implib
2271@item --out-implib @var{file}
2272Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2273the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2274library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2275may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2276behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2277step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2278the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2279
36af4a4e
JJ
2280@kindex -pie
2281@kindex --pic-executable
2282@item -pie
2283@itemx --pic-executable
2284@cindex position independent executables
2285Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2286ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2287libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2288address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2289normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2290defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2291
e8f6c2a5
FS
2292@kindex -no-pie
2293@item -no-pie
2294@cindex position dependent executables
2295Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2296
252b5132
RH
2297@kindex -qmagic
2298@item -qmagic
2299This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2300
2301@kindex -Qy
2302@item -Qy
2303This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2304
2305@kindex --relax
2306@cindex synthesizing linker
2307@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2308@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2309@item --relax
28d5f677 2310@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2311An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2312@ifset GENERIC
2313This option is only supported on a few targets.
2314@end ifset
2315@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2316@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2317@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2318@ifset XTENSA
2319@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2320@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2321@ifset M68HC11
2322@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2323@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2324@ifset NIOSII
2325@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2326@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2327@ifset POWERPC
2328@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2329@end ifset
252b5132 2330
ccd9fae5 2331On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2332global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2333addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2334synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2335instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2336
2337On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2338debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2339@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2340This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2341family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2342@end ifset
2343
ccd9fae5
NC
2344On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2345@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2346
ccd9fae5
NC
2347On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2348and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
5c14cc55 2349
252b5132
RH
2350@cindex retaining specified symbols
2351@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2352@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2353@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2354@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2355Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2356discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2357symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2358@ifset GENERIC
2359(such as VxWorks)
2360@end ifset
2361where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2362run-time memory.
2363
2364@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2365or symbols needed for relocations.
2366
2367You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2368line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2369
2370@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2371@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2372@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2373@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2374Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2375linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2376arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2377them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2378
2379The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2380are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2381description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2382in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2383have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2384
2385If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2386contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2387is defined.
252b5132 2388
ff5dcc92 2389The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2390SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2391@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2392runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2393options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2394gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2395file systems.
252b5132 2396
ff5dcc92 2397For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2398followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2399the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2400@end ifset
2401
2402@ifset GENERIC
2403@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2404@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2405@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2406When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2407happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2408of the input files.
2409
2410When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2411non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2412shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2413explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2414specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2415@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2416either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2417appearing multiple times.
2418
e680a6b6
NC
2419The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2420directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2421containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2422and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
242364-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2424
2425The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2426@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2427supported.
2428
28c309a2
NC
2429This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2430that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2431is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2432runtime linker would do.
2433
252b5132 2434The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2435libraries:
d8e4137b 2436
252b5132
RH
2437@enumerate
2438@item
ff5dcc92 2439Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2440@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2441Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2442between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2443specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2444used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2445at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2446by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2447the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2448@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2449On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2450@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2451environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2452@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2453On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2454directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2455@item
a1b8d843 2456For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2457variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2458@item
ec4eb78a
L
2459For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2460@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2461libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2462@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2463@item
d8e4137b
NC
2464For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2465exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2466to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2467defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2468configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2469@item
2470For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2471the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2472header file.
2473@item
364d7729
AM
2474Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2475linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2476by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2477@item
2478The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2479@item
2480Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2481@item
2482Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2483linker script.
252b5132
RH
2484@end enumerate
2485
6418520e
NC
2486Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2487the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2488is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2489library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2490@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2491directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2492this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2493@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2494of the first.
2495
252b5132
RH
2496If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2497warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2498
252b5132
RH
2499@end ifset
2500
2501@kindex -shared
2502@kindex -Bshareable
2503@item -shared
2504@itemx -Bshareable
2505@cindex shared libraries
2506Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2507and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2508shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2509undefined symbols in the link.
2510
252b5132 2511@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2512@item --sort-common
2513@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2514@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2515This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2516ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2517sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2518eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2519between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2520specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2521
2509a395
SL
2522@kindex --sort-section=name
2523@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2524This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2525patterns in the linker script.
2526
2509a395
SL
2527@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2528@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2529This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2530patterns in the linker script.
2531
a70f34c0
NC
2532@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2533@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2534This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2535.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2536post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2537
252b5132 2538@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2539@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2540Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2541each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2542size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2543
2544@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2545@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2546Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2547output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2548This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2549certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2550cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2551that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2552support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2553input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2554more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2555many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2556
2557@kindex --stats
2558@item --stats
2559Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2560as execution time and memory usage.
2561
2509a395 2562@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2563@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2564Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2565configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2566that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2567
a70f34c0
NC
2568@kindex --task-link
2569@item --task-link
2570This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2571file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2572
252b5132
RH
2573@kindex --traditional-format
2574@cindex traditional format
2575@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2576For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2577the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2578use the traditional format instead.
2579
2580@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2581For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2582symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2583full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2584@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2585trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2586combine duplicate entries.
2587
2509a395
SL
2588@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2589@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2590Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2591address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2592times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2593line.
2594@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2595for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2596@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2597should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2598sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2599
2509a395
SL
2600@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2601@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2602@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2603@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2604@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2605@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2606@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2607Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2608@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2609
2509a395
SL
2610@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2611@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2612@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2613When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2614byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2615
9d5777a3
RM
2616@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2617@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2618@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2619When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2620the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2621text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2622
0d705e9f
AM
2623@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2624@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2625@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2626When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2627model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2628
560e09e9
NC
2629@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2630@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2631Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2632values for @samp{method}:
2633
2634@table @samp
2635@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2636Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2637
2638@item report-all
da8bce14 2639Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2640
2641@item ignore-in-object-files
2642Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2643ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2644
2645@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2646Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2647ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2648when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2649libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2650command line.
2651@end table
2652
2653The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2654by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2655
2656Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2657unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2658can change this to a warning.
2659
1715a13c
L
2660@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2661@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2662@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2663@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2664Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2665supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2666the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2667argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2668
2669@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2670@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2671@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2672Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2673used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2674about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2675is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2676see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2677use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2678symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2679@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2680
7ce691ae 2681@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2682@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2683@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2684@item --warn-common
2685Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2686a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2687but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2688you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2689Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2690warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2691
2692There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2693
2694@table @samp
2695@item int i = 1;
2696A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2697file.
2698
2699@item extern int i;
2700An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2701There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2702variable somewhere.
2703
2704@item int i;
2705A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2706variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2707The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2708single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2709size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2710a definition of the same variable.
2711@end table
2712
2713The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2714Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2715just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2716encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2717a common symbol.
2718
2719@enumerate
2720@item
2721Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2722definition for the symbol.
2723@smallexample
2724@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2725 overridden by definition
2726@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2727@end smallexample
2728
2729@item
2730Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2731the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2732except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2733@smallexample
2734@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2735 overriding common
2736@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2737@end smallexample
2738
2739@item
2740Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2741@smallexample
2742@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2743 of `@var{symbol}'
2744@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2745@end smallexample
2746
2747@item
2748Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2749@smallexample
2750@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2751 overridden by larger common
2752@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2753@end smallexample
2754
2755@item
2756Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2757the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2758encountered in a different order.
2759@smallexample
2760@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2761 overriding smaller common
2762@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2763@end smallexample
2764@end enumerate
2765
2766@kindex --warn-constructors
2767@item --warn-constructors
2768Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2769object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2770detect the use of global constructors.
2771
65daf5be 2772@kindex --warn-execstack
bd7d326d 2773@cindex warnings, on executable stack
65daf5be
NC
2774@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2775@item --warn-execstack
2776@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2777On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2778messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2779default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2780line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2781@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2782
2783On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2784executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2785stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
bd7d326d 2786noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
65daf5be
NC
2787can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2788
2789Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2790stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2791bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2792an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2793flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2794section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2795some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2796executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2797crafted assembler files.
2798
252b5132
RH
2799@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2800@item --warn-multiple-gp
2801Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2802This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2803Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2804section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2805of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2806base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2807base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2808bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2809large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2810values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2811option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2812
2813@kindex --warn-once
2814@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2815@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2816@item --warn-once
2817Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2818which refers to it.
2819
ba951afb
NC
2820@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2821@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2822@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2823@item --warn-rwx-segments
2824@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2825Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2826all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2827segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2828warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2829created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2830not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2831
2832These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2833@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2834@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2835
252b5132
RH
2836@kindex --warn-section-align
2837@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2838@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2839@item --warn-section-align
2840Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2841alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2842The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2843is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2844the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2845
a6dbf402
L
2846@kindex --warn-textrel
2847@item --warn-textrel
2848Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2849or shared object.
8fdd7217 2850
a0c402a5
L
2851@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2852@item --warn-alternate-em
2853Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2854
560e09e9
NC
2855@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2856@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2857If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2858@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2859This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2860
2861@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2862@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2863This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2864it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2865
252b5132
RH
2866@kindex --whole-archive
2867@cindex including an entire archive
2868@item --whole-archive
2869For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2870@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2871in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2872files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2873library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2874library. This option may be used more than once.
2875
7ec229ce 2876Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2877about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2878Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2879list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2880your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2881
2509a395
SL
2882@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2883@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2884Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2885@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2886undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2887@var{symbol}.
2888
2889This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2890wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2891wishes to call the system function, it should call
2892@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2893
2894Here is a trivial example:
2895
2896@smallexample
2897void *
cc2f008e 2898__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2899@{
cc2f008e 2900 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2901 return __real_malloc (c);
2902@}
2903@end smallexample
2904
ff5dcc92 2905If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2906all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2907instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2908call the real @code{malloc} function.
2909
2910You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2911links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2912you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2913file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2914call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2915
4ea904ed
SH
2916Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2917internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2918@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2919@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2920
2921@smallexample
2922int
2923f (void)
2924@{
2925 return 123;
2926@}
2927
2928int
2929g (void)
2930@{
2931 return f();
2932@}
2933@end smallexample
2934
6aa29e7b 2935@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2936@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2937@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2938@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2939Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2940(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2941section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2942
e41b3a13
JJ
2943@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2944@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2945Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2946generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
cf0e0a0b 2947if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
1bd123bd 2948controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
cf0e0a0b 2949generated code sections like PLT.
e41b3a13 2950
6c1439be
L
2951@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2952@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2953@item --enable-new-dtags
2954@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2955This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2956systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2957@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2958and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2959If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2960created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2961those options are only available for ELF systems.
2962
2d643429 2963@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2964@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2965Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2966close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2967time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2968increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2969value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2970
fdc90cb4
JJ
2971@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2972@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2973Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2974@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2975new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2976the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2977hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2978but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2979
0ce398f1
L
2980@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2981@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2982@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2983@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2984@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
0ce398f1
L
2985@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2986@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2987@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2988@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2989@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
9af89fba
NC
2990On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2991compressed using zlib.
2992
2993@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2994sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2995DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2996instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2997also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2998sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2999
3000The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
3001@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
3002
2cac01e3
FS
3003@option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
3004zstd.
3005
9af89fba
NC
3006Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
3007sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
3008for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
3009uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
3010
3011The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3012involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3013default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3014@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 3015
35835446
JR
3016@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3017@item --reduce-memory-overheads
3018This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 3019linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 3020for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
3021about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3022
4f9c04f7 3023Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 30241021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 3025run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
3026has been used.
3027
3028The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3029enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 3030
a8dde0a2
L
3031@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3032@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3033@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3034of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3035maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3036
c0065db7
RM
3037@kindex --build-id
3038@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3039@item --build-id
3040@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 3041Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 3042or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
3043unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3044@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3045@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3046@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3047the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3048string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3049@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3050is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
3051
3052The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3053that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3054unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3055to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3056file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3057string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
3058
3059Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3060@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
9e2bb0cb
LB
3061
3062@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3063@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3064Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3065contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3066specification. For more information see:
3067https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3068If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3069creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
3070occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
3071If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3072will be validated.
252b5132
RH
3073@end table
3074
0285c67d
NC
3075@c man end
3076
36f63dca 3077@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 3078
0285c67d
NC
3079@c man begin OPTIONS
3080
ff5dcc92 3081The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
3082the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3083normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3084use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3085@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3086like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3087symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3088object file).
3089
3090In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 3091support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
3092PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3093values by either a space or an equals sign.
3094
ff5dcc92 3095@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
3096
3097@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3098@item --add-stdcall-alias
3099If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3100as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 3101[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3102
3103@kindex --base-file
3104@item --base-file @var{file}
3105Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3106addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3107@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 3108[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
3109
3110@kindex --dll
3111@item --dll
3112Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 3113@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 3114file.
bb10df36 3115[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3116
88183869
DK
3117@kindex --enable-long-section-names
3118@kindex --disable-long-section-names
3119@item --enable-long-section-names
3120@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 3121The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 3122the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
3123for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3124fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
3125to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3126allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3127disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3128generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3129as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
3130with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3131GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
3132information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3133option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3134section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3135when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3136image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
3137[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3138
252b5132
RH
3139@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3140@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3141@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3142@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3143If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 3144do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
3145only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3146resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3147undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3148@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3149to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3150warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3151import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 3152to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 3153feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 3154@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 3155mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 3156[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3157
522f09cd
KT
3158@kindex --leading-underscore
3159@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3160@item --leading-underscore
3161@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3162For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3163in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3164disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3165
252b5132
RH
3166@cindex DLLs, creating
3167@kindex --export-all-symbols
3168@item --export-all-symbols
3169If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3170be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3171otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3172explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3173attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3174option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 3175@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 3176@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
3177exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3178re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3179such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3180@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3181@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3182Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3183not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3184extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3185(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3186These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3187@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3188@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3189@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3190@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3191[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3192
3193@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3194@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3195Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3196exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3197[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3198
2927aaca
NC
3199@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3200@item --exclude-all-symbols
3201Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3202[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3203
252b5132
RH
3204@kindex --file-alignment
3205@item --file-alignment
3206Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3207file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3208512.
bb10df36 3209[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3210
3211@cindex heap size
3212@kindex --heap
3213@item --heap @var{reserve}
3214@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3215Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3216to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3217committed.
bb10df36 3218[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3219
3220@cindex image base
3221@kindex --image-base
3222@item --image-base @var{value}
3223Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3224the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3225is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3226your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3227other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3228for dlls.
bb10df36 3229[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3230
3231@kindex --kill-at
3232@item --kill-at
3233If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3234symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3235[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3236
26d2d8a2
BF
3237@kindex --large-address-aware
3238@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3239If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3240header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3241greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3242or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3243section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3244[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3245
f69a2f97
NC
3246@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3247@item --disable-large-address-aware
3248Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3249This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3250driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3251addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3252[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3253
252b5132
RH
3254@kindex --major-image-version
3255@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3256Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3257[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3258
3259@kindex --major-os-version
3260@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3261Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3262[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3263
3264@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3265@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3266Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3267[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3268
3269@kindex --minor-image-version
3270@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3271Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3272[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3273
3274@kindex --minor-os-version
3275@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3276Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3277[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3278
3279@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3280@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3281Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3282[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3283
3284@cindex DEF files, creating
3285@cindex DLLs, creating
3286@kindex --output-def
3287@item --output-def @var{file}
3288The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3289file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3290(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3291library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3292automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3293[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3294
b044cda1 3295@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3296@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3297@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3298@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3299Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3300@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3301By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3302for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3303execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3304[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3305
3306@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3307@item --disable-auto-image-base
3308Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3309user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3310default.
bb10df36 3311[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3312
3313@cindex DLLs, linking to
3314@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3315@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3316When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3317search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3318@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3319between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3320uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3321@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3322[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3323
3324@kindex --enable-auto-import
3325@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3326Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3327DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3328mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3329[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3330
3331The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3332feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3333
3334Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3335of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3336PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3337
e2a83dd0
NC
3338Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3339data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3340placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3341around a problem with consts that is described here:
3342http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3343
4d8907ac
DS
3344Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3345see this message:
0d888aac 3346
ece2d90e 3347"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3348documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3349
ece2d90e
NC
3350This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3351ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3352allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3353fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3354constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3355multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3356this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3357of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3358the warning, and exit.
3359
3360There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3361data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3362
2fa9fc65
NC
3363One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3364of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3365this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3366
c0065db7
RM
3367A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3368that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3369there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3370a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3371
3372@example
3373extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3374extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3375 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3376@end example
3377
3378or
3379
3380@example
3381extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3382extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3383 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3384@end example
3385
c0065db7 3386For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3387is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3388
3389@example
3390extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3391extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3392 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3393@end example
3394
c406afaf
NC
3395or
3396
3397@example
3398extern long long extern_ll;
3399extern_ll -->
3400 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3401@end example
3402
2fa9fc65 3403A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3404'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3405@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3406requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3407building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3408merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3409between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3410constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3411
3412Original:
3413@example
3414--foo.h
3415extern int arr[];
3416--foo.c
3417#include "foo.h"
3418void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3419 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3420@}
3421@end example
3422
3423Solution 1:
3424@example
3425--foo.h
3426extern int arr[];
3427--foo.c
3428#include "foo.h"
3429void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3430 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3431 volatile int *parr = arr;
3432 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3433@}
3434@end example
3435
3436Solution 2:
3437@example
3438--foo.h
3439/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3440#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3441 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3442#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3443#else
3444#define FOO_IMPORT
3445#endif
3446extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3447--foo.c
3448#include "foo.h"
3449void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3450 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3451@}
3452@end example
3453
c0065db7 3454A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3455library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3456for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3457functions).
b044cda1
CW
3458
3459@kindex --disable-auto-import
3460@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3461Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3462@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3463[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3464
2fa9fc65
NC
3465@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3466@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3467If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3468that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3469a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3470environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3471[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3472
3473@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3474@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3475Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3476[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3477
b044cda1
CW
3478@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3479@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3480Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3481[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3482
252b5132
RH
3483@kindex --section-alignment
3484@item --section-alignment
3485Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3486addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3487[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3488
3489@cindex stack size
3490@kindex --stack
3491@item --stack @var{reserve}
3492@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3493Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3494to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3495committed.
bb10df36 3496[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3497
3498@kindex --subsystem
3499@item --subsystem @var{which}
3500@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3501@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3502Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3503legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3504@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3505the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3506@var{which}.
bb10df36 3507[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3508
2f563b51
DK
3509The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3510of the PE file header:
3511[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3512
2d5c3743
NC
3513@kindex --high-entropy-va
3514@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3515@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3516Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3517(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3518
dc9bd8c9
HD
3519This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3520@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3521
2f563b51
DK
3522@kindex --dynamicbase
3523@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3524@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3525The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3526randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3527Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3528can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3529This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3530
3531@kindex --forceinteg
3532@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3533@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3534Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3535default.
2f563b51
DK
3536
3537@kindex --nxcompat
3538@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3539@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3540The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3541This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3542targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3543
3544@kindex --no-isolation
3545@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3546@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3547Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3548This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3549
3550@kindex --no-seh
3551@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3552@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3553The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3554this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3555
3556@kindex --no-bind
3557@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3558@itemx --disable-no-bind
3559Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3560
3561@kindex --wdmdriver
3562@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3563@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3564The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3565by default.
9d5777a3 3566
2f563b51
DK
3567@kindex --tsaware
3568@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3569@itemx --disable-tsaware
3570The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3571default.
2f563b51 3572
0cb112f7
CF
3573@kindex --insert-timestamp
3574@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3575@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3576Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3577as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3578other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3579will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3580same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3581can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3582that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3583identically.
dc9bd8c9 3584
b5c37946
SJ
3585If @option{--insert-timestamp} is active then the time inserted is
3586either the time that the linking takes place or, if the
3587@code{SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH} environment variable is defined, the number
3588of seconds since Unix epoch as specified by that variable.
3589
dc9bd8c9
HD
3590@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3591@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3592@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3593Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3594is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3595This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3596@end table
3597
0285c67d
NC
3598@c man end
3599
ac145307
BS
3600@ifset C6X
3601@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3602
3603@c man begin OPTIONS
3604
3605The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3606libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3607all executables use an index of 0.
3608
3609@table @gcctabopt
3610
3611@kindex --dsbt-size
3612@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3613This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3614or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3615entries.
3616
3617@kindex --dsbt-index
3618@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3619This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3620to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3621executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3622@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3623
fbd9ad90
PB
3624@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3625The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3626exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3627
ac145307
BS
3628@end table
3629
3630@c man end
3631@end ifset
3632
b8891f8d
AJ
3633@ifset CSKY
3634@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3635
3636@c man begin OPTIONS
3637
3638@table @gcctabopt
3639
3640@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3641@item --branch-stub
3642This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3643sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3644usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3645can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3646the compiler or assembler.
3647
3648@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3649@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3650This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3651It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3652be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3653stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3654sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3655@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3656linker should choose suitable defaults.
3657
3658@end table
3659
3660@c man end
3661@end ifset
3662
93fd0973
SC
3663@ifset M68HC11
3664@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3665
3666@c man begin OPTIONS
3667
3668The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3669memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3670
3671@table @gcctabopt
3672
3673@kindex --no-trampoline
3674@item --no-trampoline
3675This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3676is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3677instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3678
3679@kindex --bank-window
3680@item --bank-window @var{name}
3681This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3682the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3683The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3684paging and addresses within the memory window.
3685
3686@end table
3687
3688@c man end
3689@end ifset
3690
7fb9f789
NC
3691@ifset M68K
3692@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3693
3694@c man begin OPTIONS
3695
3696The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3697when linking for 68K targets.
3698
3699@table @gcctabopt
3700
3701@kindex --got
3702@item --got=@var{type}
3703This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3704@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3705@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3706Info entry for @file{ld}.
3707
3708@end table
3709
3710@c man end
3711@end ifset
3712
833794fc
MR
3713@ifset MIPS
3714@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3715
3716@c man begin OPTIONS
3717
3718The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3719generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3720linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3721
3722@table @gcctabopt
3723
3724@kindex --insn32
3725@item --insn32
3726@kindex --no-insn32
3727@itemx --no-insn32
3728These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3729generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3730or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
373132-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3732used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3733possible.
3734
8b10b0b3
MR
3735@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3736@item --ignore-branch-isa
3737@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3738@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3739These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3740transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3741accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3742is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3743instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3744equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3745calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3746a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3747an error.
3748
3734320d
MF
3749@kindex --compact-branches
3750@item --compact-branches
3751@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3752@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3753These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3754in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3755
833794fc
MR
3756@end table
3757
3758@c man end
3759@end ifset
3760
fa1477dc
SC
3761
3762@ifset PDP11
3763@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3764
3765@c man begin OPTIONS
3766
3767For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3768produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3769for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3770targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3771defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3772here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3773
3774@table @gcctabopt
3775
3776@kindex -N
3777@item -N
3778@kindex --omagic
3779@itemx --omagic
3780
3781Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3782indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3783shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3784writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3785the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3786programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3787from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3788
3789@kindex -n
3790@item -n
3791@kindex --nmagic
3792@itemx --nmagic
3793
3794Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3795indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3796be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3797file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3798byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3799a @emph{pure executable} format.
3800
3801@kindex -z
3802@item -z
3803@kindex --imagic
3804@itemx --imagic
3805
3806Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3807indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3808data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3809instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3810larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3811to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3812shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3813option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3814and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3815this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3816executable} format.
3817
3818@kindex --no-omagic
3819@item --no-omagic
3820
3821Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3822
3823@end table
3824
3825@c man end
3826@end ifset
3827
252b5132
RH
3828@ifset UsesEnvVars
3829@node Environment
3830@section Environment Variables
3831
0285c67d
NC
3832@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3833
560e09e9 3834You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3835@ifclear SingleFormat
3836@code{GNUTARGET},
3837@end ifclear
3838@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3839
36f63dca 3840@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3841@kindex GNUTARGET
3842@cindex default input format
3843@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3844use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3845of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3846@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3847of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3848attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3849this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3850there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3851object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3852BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3853in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3854@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3855
3856@kindex LDEMULATION
3857@cindex default emulation
3858@cindex emulation, default
3859@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3860@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3861behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3862available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3863the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3864variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3865linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3866
3867@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3868@cindex demangling, default
3869Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3870@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3871default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3872a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3873may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3874options.
3875
0285c67d
NC
3876@c man end
3877@end ifset
3878
252b5132
RH
3879@node Scripts
3880@chapter Linker Scripts
3881
3882@cindex scripts
3883@cindex linker scripts
3884@cindex command files
3885Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3886written in the linker command language.
3887
3888The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3889the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3890the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3891more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3892direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3893described below.
3894
3895The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3896yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3897linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3898to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3899such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3900
3901You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3902line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3903default linker script.
3904
3905You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3906to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3907Linker Scripts}.
3908
3909@menu
3910* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3911* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3912* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3913* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3914* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3915* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3916* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3917* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3918* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3919* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3920* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3921@end menu
3922
3923@node Basic Script Concepts
3924@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3925@cindex linker script concepts
3926We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3927describe the linker script language.
3928
3929The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3930file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3931@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3932The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3933purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3934among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3935section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3936in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3937
3938Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3939also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3940contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3941the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3942A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3943area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3944loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3945which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3946of debugging information.
3947
3948Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3949first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3950the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3951@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3952section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3953same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3954is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3955(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3956based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3957RAM address would be the VMA.
3958
3959You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3960program with the @samp{-h} option.
3961
3962Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3963@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3964has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3965information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3966will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3967static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3968referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3969
3970You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3971program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3972option.
3973
3974@node Script Format
3975@section Linker Script Format
3976@cindex linker script format
3977Linker scripts are text files.
3978
3979You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3980either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3981symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3982generally ignored.
3983
3984Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3985If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3986otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3987double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3988file name.
3989
3990You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3991@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3992to whitespace.
3993
3994@node Simple Example
3995@section Simple Linker Script Example
3996@cindex linker script example
3997@cindex example of linker script
3998Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3999
4000The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
4001@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
4002memory layout of the output file.
4003
4004The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
4005describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
4006code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
4007@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
4008Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
4009your input files.
4010
4011For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
40120x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
4013linker script which will do that:
4014@smallexample
4015SECTIONS
4016@{
4017 . = 0x10000;
4018 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4019 . = 0x8000000;
4020 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4021 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4022@}
4023@end smallexample
4024
4025You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4026followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4027descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4028
252b5132
RH
4029The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4030sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4031counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4032other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4033current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4034incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4035@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4036
4037The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4038required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4039after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4040which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4041wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4042means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4043
4044Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4045@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4046@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4047
4048The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4049the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4050at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4051output section, the value of the location counter will be
4052@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4053effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 4054immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
4055
4056The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4057alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4058example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4059sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4060may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4061sections.
4062
4063That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4064
4065@node Simple Commands
4066@section Simple Linker Script Commands
4067@cindex linker script simple commands
4068In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4069
4070@menu
4071* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4072* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4073@ifclear SingleFormat
4074* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4075@end ifclear
4076
4a93e180 4077* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
4078* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4079@end menu
4080
4081@node Entry Point
36f63dca 4082@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
4083@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4084@cindex start of execution
4085@cindex first instruction
4086@cindex entry point
4087The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4088point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4089entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4090@smallexample
4091ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4092@end smallexample
4093
4094There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4095entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4096stopping when one of them succeeds:
4097@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 4098@item
252b5132 4099the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 4100@item
252b5132 4101the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 4102@item
a094d01f 4103the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 4104targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 4105check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 4106@item
5226a6a8
NC
4107the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4108executable is being created - the code section is usually
5c14cc55 4109@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 4110@item
252b5132
RH
4111The address @code{0}.
4112@end itemize
4113
4114@node File Commands
36f63dca 4115@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
4116@cindex linker script file commands
4117Several linker script commands deal with files.
4118
4119@table @code
4120@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4121@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4122@cindex including a linker script
4123Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4124be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 4125with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
412610 levels deep.
4127
4006703d
NS
4128You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4129@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4130
252b5132
RH
4131@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4132@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4133@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4134@cindex input files in linker scripts
4135@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4136@cindex linker script input object files
4137The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4138in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4139
4140For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4141a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4142then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4143
4144In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4145script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4146
e3f2db7f
AO
4147In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4148with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4149located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
4150for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4151@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4152filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4153@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4154
4155If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4156the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4157found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4158not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4159path.
252b5132 4160
ff5dcc92 4161If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 4162name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
4163@samp{-l}.
4164
4165When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4166files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4167script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4168
4169@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4170@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4171@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4172@cindex grouping input files
4173The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4174files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4175new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 4176in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 4177
b717d30e
JJ
4178@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4179@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4180@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4181This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4182commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4183as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4184with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4185when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4186@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4187and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4188setting afterwards.
4189
252b5132
RH
4190@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4191@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4192@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4193The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4194@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4195@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4196Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4197precedence.
4198
4199You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4200output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4201
4202@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4203@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4204@cindex library search path in linker script
4205@cindex archive search path in linker script
4206@cindex search path in linker script
4207The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4208@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4209@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4210on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4211are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4212the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4213
4214@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4215@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4216@cindex first input file
4217The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4218that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4219though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4220when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4221first file.
4222@end table
4223
4224@ifclear SingleFormat
4225@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4226@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4227A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4228
4229@table @code
4230@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4231@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4232@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4233@cindex output file format in linker script
4234The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4235output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4236exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4237(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4238line option takes precedence.
4239
4240You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4241formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4242This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4243desired endianness.
4244
4245If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4246will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4247output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4248used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4249
4250For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4251command:
4252@smallexample
4253OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4254@end smallexample
4255This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4256@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4257option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4258format.
4259
4260@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4261@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4262@cindex input file format in linker script
4263The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4264files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4265This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4266(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4267is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4268command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4269@end table
4270@end ifclear
4271
4a93e180
NC
4272@node REGION_ALIAS
4273@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4274@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4275@cindex region alias
4276@cindex region names
4277
4278Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4279@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4280
4281@smallexample
4282REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4283@end smallexample
4284
4285The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4286memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4287to memory regions. An example follows.
4288
4289Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4290memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4291that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4292non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4293access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4294read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4295sections:
4296
4297@itemize @bullet
4298@item
4299@code{.text} program code;
4300@item
4301@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4302@item
4303@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4304@item
4305@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4306@end itemize
4307
4308The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4309part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4310output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4311systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4312@code{C}:
4313@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4314@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4315@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4316@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4317@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4318@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4319@end multitable
4320The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4321loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4322the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4323the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4324
4325The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4326includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4327memory layout:
4328@smallexample
4329INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4330
4331SECTIONS
4332 @{
4333 .text :
4334 @{
4335 *(.text)
4336 @} > REGION_TEXT
4337 .rodata :
4338 @{
4339 *(.rodata)
4340 rodata_end = .;
4341 @} > REGION_RODATA
4342 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4343 @{
4344 data_start = .;
4345 *(.data)
4346 @} > REGION_DATA
4347 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4348 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4349 .bss :
4350 @{
4351 *(.bss)
4352 @} > REGION_BSS
4353 @}
4354@end smallexample
4355
4356Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4357regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4358variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4359@table @code
4360@item A
4361Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4362@smallexample
4363MEMORY
4364 @{
4365 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4366 @}
4367
4368REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4369REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4370REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4371REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4372@end smallexample
4373@item B
4374Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4375into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4376@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4377@smallexample
4378MEMORY
4379 @{
4380 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4381 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4382 @}
4383
4384REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4385REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4386REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4387REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4388@end smallexample
4389@item C
4390Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4391@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4392initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4393system start into the @code{RAM}.
4394@smallexample
4395MEMORY
4396 @{
4397 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4398 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4399 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4400 @}
4401
4402REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4403REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4404REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4405REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4406@end smallexample
4407@end table
4408
4409It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4410@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4411necessary:
4412@smallexample
4413#include <string.h>
4414
4415extern char data_start [];
4416extern char data_size [];
4417extern char data_load_start [];
4418
4419void copy_data(void)
4420@{
4421 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4422 @{
4423 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4424 @}
4425@}
4426@end smallexample
4427
252b5132 4428@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4429@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4430There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4431
4432@table @code
4433@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4434@kindex ASSERT
4435@cindex assertion in linker script
4436Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4437with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4438
fd1c4238
NC
4439Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4440take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4441inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4442for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4443symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4444
4445@smallexample
4446 .stack :
4447 @{
4448 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4449 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4450 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4451 @}
4452@end smallexample
4453
4454will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4455PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4456can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4457
4458@smallexample
4459 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4460 .stack :
4461 @{
4462 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4463 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4464 @}
4465@end smallexample
4466
4467will work.
4468
252b5132
RH
4469@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4470@kindex EXTERN
4471@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4472Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4473symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4474modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4475each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4476command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4477
4478@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4479@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4480@cindex common allocation in linker script
4481This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4482to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4483output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4484
4818e05f
AM
4485@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4486@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4487@cindex common allocation in linker script
4488This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4489command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4490to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4491
7bdf4127
AB
4492@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4493@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4494@cindex group allocation in linker script
4495@cindex section groups
4496@cindex COMDAT
4497This command has the same effect as the
4498@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4499@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4500and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4501specified (@samp{-r}).
4502
53d25da6
AM
4503@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4504@kindex INSERT
4505@cindex insert user script into default script
4506This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4507augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4508inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4509@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4510default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4511sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4512linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4513insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4514linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4515default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4516of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4517to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4518is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4519
4520@smallexample
4521SECTIONS
4522@{
4523 OVERLAY :
4524 @{
4525 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4526 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4527 @}
4528@}
4529INSERT AFTER .text;
4530@end smallexample
4531
31f14901
AM
4532Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4533script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4534of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4535The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4536command line.
4537
252b5132
RH
4538@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4539@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4540@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4541This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4542references among certain output sections.
4543
4544In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4545using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4546will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4547errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4548a function defined in the other section.
4549
4550The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4551@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4552an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4553@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4554names.
4555
cdf96953
MF
4556@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4557@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4558@cindex cross references
4559This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4560references to one section from a list of other sections.
4561
4562The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4563output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4564a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4565there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4566must never call back.
4567
4568The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4569The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4570If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4571the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4572status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4573names, not input section names.
4574
252b5132
RH
4575@ifclear SingleFormat
4576@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4577@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4578@cindex machine architecture
4579@cindex architecture
4580Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4581of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4582architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4583the @samp{-f} option.
4584@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4585
4586@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4587@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4588This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4589@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4590in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4591@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4592@end table
4593
4594@node Assignments
4595@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4596@cindex assignment in scripts
4597@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4598@cindex variables, defining
4599You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4600the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4601
4602@menu
4603* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4604* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4605* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4606* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4607* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4608@end menu
4609
4610@node Simple Assignments
4611@subsection Simple Assignments
4612
4613You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4614
4615@table @code
4616@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4617@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4618@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4619@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4620@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4621@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4622@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4623@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4624@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4625@end table
4626
4627The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4628@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4629defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4630
4631The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4632may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4633
4634The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4635
4636Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4637
4638You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4639statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4640section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4641
4642The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4643expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4644
4645Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4646assignments may be used:
4647
4648@smallexample
4649floating_point = 0;
4650SECTIONS
4651@{
4652 .text :
4653 @{
4654 *(.text)
4655 _etext = .;
4656 @}
156e34dd 4657 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4658 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4659@}
4660@end smallexample
4661@noindent
4662In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4663zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4664the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4665defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4666upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4667
eb8476a6
MR
4668@node HIDDEN
4669@subsection HIDDEN
4670@cindex HIDDEN
4671For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4672exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4673
4674Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4675@code{HIDDEN}:
4676
4677@smallexample
4678HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4679SECTIONS
4680@{
4681 .text :
4682 @{
4683 *(.text)
4684 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4685 @}
4686 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4687 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4688@}
4689@end smallexample
4690@noindent
4691In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4692
252b5132
RH
4693@node PROVIDE
4694@subsection PROVIDE
4695@cindex PROVIDE
4696In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4697only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4698the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4699@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4700@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4701@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4702@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4703@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4704
4705Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4706@smallexample
4707SECTIONS
4708@{
4709 .text :
4710 @{
4711 *(.text)
4712 _etext = .;
4713 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4714 @}
4715@}
4716@end smallexample
4717
4718In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4719underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4720on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4721underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4722If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4723linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4724
b0daac83
NC
4725Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4726defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4727that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4728when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4729@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4730
7af8e998
L
4731@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4732@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4733@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4734Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4735hidden and won't be exported.
4736
73ae6183
NC
4737@node Source Code Reference
4738@subsection Source Code Reference
4739
4740Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4741intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4742a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4743symbol that does not have a value.
4744
4745Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4746transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4747stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4748prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4749mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4750of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4751variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4752linker script variable might be referred to as:
4753
4754@smallexample
4755 extern int foo;
4756@end smallexample
4757
4758But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4759
4760@smallexample
4761 _foo = 1000;
4762@end smallexample
4763
4764In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4765transformation has taken place.
4766
4767When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4768things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4769in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4770second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4771table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4772contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4773value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4774
4775@smallexample
4776 int foo = 1000;
4777@end smallexample
4778
10bf6894 4779creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4780holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4781number 1000 is initially stored.
4782
4783When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4784first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4785memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4786So:
4787
4788@smallexample
4789 foo = 1;
4790@end smallexample
4791
4792looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4793associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4794address. Whereas:
4795
4796@smallexample
4797 int * a = & foo;
4798@end smallexample
4799
10bf6894 4800looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4801and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4802the variable @samp{a}.
4803
4804Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4805the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4806an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4807
4808@smallexample
4809 foo = 1000;
4810@end smallexample
4811
4812creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4813the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4814address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4815linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4816access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4817
4818Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4819you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4820use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4821section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4822linker script contains these declarations:
4823
4824@smallexample
4825@group
4826 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4827 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4828 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4829@end group
4830@end smallexample
4831
4832Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4833
4834@smallexample
4835@group
4836 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4837
73ae6183
NC
4838 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4839@end group
4840@end smallexample
4841
4842Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4843Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4844arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4845
4846@smallexample
4847@group
4848 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4849
4850 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4851@end group
4852@end smallexample
4853
4854Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4855operators.
73ae6183 4856
252b5132 4857@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4858@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4859@kindex SECTIONS
4860The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4861into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4862
4863The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4864@smallexample
4865SECTIONS
4866@{
4867 @var{sections-command}
4868 @var{sections-command}
4869 @dots{}
4870@}
4871@end smallexample
4872
4873Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4874
4875@itemize @bullet
4876@item
4877an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4878@item
4879a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4880@item
4881an output section description
4882@item
4883an overlay description
4884@end itemize
4885
4886The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4887@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4888those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4889understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4890the layout of the output file.
4891
4892Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4893below.
4894
4895If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4896linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4897section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4898input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4899example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4900in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4901
4902@menu
4903* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4904* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4905* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4906* Input Section:: Input section description
4907* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4908* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4909* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4910* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4911* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4912@end menu
4913
4914@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4915@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4916The full description of an output section looks like this:
4917@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4918@group
7e7d5768 4919@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4920 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4921 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4922 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4923 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4924 @{
4925 @var{output-section-command}
4926 @var{output-section-command}
4927 @dots{}
abc9061b 4928 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4929@end group
4930@end smallexample
4931
4932Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4933
4934The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4935name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4936The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4937the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4938The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4939
4940Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4941
4942@itemize @bullet
4943@item
4944a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4945@item
4946an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4947@item
4948data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4949@item
4950a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4951@end itemize
4952
4953@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4954@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4955@cindex name, section
4956@cindex section name
4957The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4958meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4959support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4960must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4961example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4962output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4963names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4964quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4965characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4966commas must be quoted.
4967
4968The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4969Discarding}.
4970
4971@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4972@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4973@cindex address, section
4974@cindex section address
4975The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4976address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4977is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4978
4979If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4980section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4981to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4982alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4983contained within the output section.
4984
4985The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4986
4987@itemize @bullet
4988@item
4989If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4990is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4991in that region.
4992
4993@item
4994If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4995regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4996section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4997be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4998
4999@item
5000If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
5001the output address will be based on the current value of the location
5002counter.
5003@end itemize
5004
5005@noindent
5006For example:
5007
252b5132
RH
5008@smallexample
5009.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
5010@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5011
252b5132
RH
5012@noindent
5013and
ea5cae92 5014
252b5132
RH
5015@smallexample
5016.text : @{ *(.text) @}
5017@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5018
252b5132
RH
5019@noindent
5020are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5021@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5022counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
5023counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5024input sections.
252b5132
RH
5025
5026The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5027For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5028so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5029do something like this:
5030@smallexample
5031.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5032@end smallexample
5033@noindent
5034This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5035aligned upward to the specified value.
5036
5037Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
5038location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5039sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
5040
5041@node Input Section
36f63dca 5042@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
5043@cindex input sections
5044@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5045The most common output section command is an input section description.
5046
5047The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5048You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5049in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5050map the input files into your memory layout.
5051
5052@menu
5053* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5054* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5055* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5056* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5057* Input Section Example:: Input section example
5058@end menu
5059
5060@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 5061@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
5062@cindex input section basics
5063An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5064by a list of section names in parentheses.
5065
5066The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5067describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5068
5069The most common input section description is to include all input
5070sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5071include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5072@smallexample
5073*(.text)
5074@end smallexample
5075@noindent
18625d54 5076Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 5077@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
5078of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5079match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5080example:
252b5132 5081@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5082EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5083@end smallexample
5084@noindent
5085will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5086and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5087placed inside the section list, for example:
5088@smallexample
b4346c09 5089*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 5090@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5091@noindent
5092The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5093two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5094more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
5095
5096There are two ways to include more than one section:
5097@smallexample
5098*(.text .rdata)
5099*(.text) *(.rdata)
5100@end smallexample
5101@noindent
5102The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5103@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
5104first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5105they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
5106@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5107@samp{.rdata} input sections.
5108
8f1732fc
AB
5109When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5110is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5111immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5112@smallexample
5113*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5114@end smallexample
5115@noindent
5116will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5117@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5118from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5119exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 5120could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5121@smallexample
5122*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5123@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5124@noindent
5125Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5126before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5127all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5128@smallexample
5129EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5130@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 5131
252b5132
RH
5132You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5133You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5134needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5135@smallexample
5136data.o(.data)
5137@end smallexample
5138
ae17ab41
CM
5139To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5140of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5141
5142Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5143
5144@smallexample
5145@group
5146SECTIONS @{
5147 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5148 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5149@}
5150@end group
5151@end smallexample
5152
5153In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5154input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5155@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5156@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5157whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5158
967928e9
AM
5159You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5160matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5161with no whitespace around the colon.
5162
5163@table @samp
5164@item archive:file
5165matches file within archive
5166@item archive:
5167matches the whole archive
5168@item :file
5169matches file but not one in an archive
5170@end table
5171
5172Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5173wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5174single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5175@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5176within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5177also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5178other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5179from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5180command.
5181
252b5132
RH
5182If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5183the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5184commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5185@smallexample
5186data.o
5187@end smallexample
5188
967928e9
AM
5189When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5190and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5191characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5192name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5193did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5194though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5195@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5196the archive search path.
5197
5198@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5199@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5200@cindex input section wildcards
5201@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5202@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5203@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5204In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5205name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5206
5207The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5208pattern for the file name.
5209
5210The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5211
5212@table @samp
5213@item *
5214matches any number of characters
5215@item ?
5216matches any single character
5217@item [@var{chars}]
5218matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5219character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5220@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5221@item \
5222quotes the following character
5223@end table
5224
252b5132
RH
5225File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5226specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5227does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5228
5229If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5230appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5231will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5232sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5233@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5234@smallexample
5235.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5236.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5237@end smallexample
5238
bcaa7b3e 5239@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5240Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5241in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5242this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5243pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5244@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5245into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5246
bcaa7b3e 5247@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5248@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5249@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5250alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5251alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5252needed.
bcaa7b3e 5253
02ecc8e9 5254@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5255@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5256@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5257numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5258section name before placing them in the output file. In
5259@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5260the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5261@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5262
bcaa7b3e
L
5263@cindex SORT
5264@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5265
5266When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5267can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5268
5269@enumerate
5270@item
5271@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5272It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5273sections have the same name.
5274@item
5275@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5276It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5277sections have the same alignment.
5278@item
c0065db7 5279@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5280treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5281@item
5282@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5283is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5284@item
5285All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5286@end enumerate
5287
a05a5b64 5288When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5289section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5290takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5291
5292If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5293command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5294treated as nested sorting command.
5295
5296@enumerate
5297@item
5298@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5299@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5300@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5301@item
5302@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5303@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5304@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5305@end enumerate
5306
5307If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5308command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5309
eda680f8 5310@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5311@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5312section sorting option.
5313
252b5132
RH
5314If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5315@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5316precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5317
5318This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5319files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5320sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5321The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5322with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5323linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5324@smallexample
5325@group
5326SECTIONS @{
5327 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5328 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5329 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5330 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5331@}
5332@end group
5333@end smallexample
5334
5335@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5336@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5337@cindex common symbol placement
5338@cindex uninitialized data placement
5339A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5340file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5341linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5342named @samp{COMMON}.
5343
5344You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5345other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5346particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5347input files are placed in another section.
5348
5349In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5350@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5351@smallexample
5352.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5353@end smallexample
5354
5355@cindex scommon section
5356@cindex small common symbols
5357Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5358example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5359symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5360different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5361the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5362symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5363to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5364locations.
5365
5366@cindex [COMMON]
5367You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5368notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5369@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5370
5371@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5372@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5373@cindex KEEP
5374@cindex garbage collection
5375When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5376it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5377This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5378with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5379@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5380
5381@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5382@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5383The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5384to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5385start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5386@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5387follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5388@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5389@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5390All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5391files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5392
5393@smallexample
5394@group
5395SECTIONS @{
5396 outputa 0x10000 :
5397 @{
5398 all.o
5399 foo.o (.input1)
5400 @}
36f63dca
NC
5401@end group
5402@group
252b5132
RH
5403 outputb :
5404 @{
5405 foo.o (.input2)
5406 foo1.o (.input1)
5407 @}
36f63dca
NC
5408@end group
5409@group
252b5132
RH
5410 outputc :
5411 @{
5412 *(.input1)
5413 *(.input2)
5414 @}
5415@}
5416@end group
a1ab1d2a 5417@end smallexample
252b5132 5418
cbd0eecf
L
5419If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5420and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5421automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5422__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5423indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5424respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5425C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
75bd292b 5426
252b5132 5427@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5428@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5429@cindex data
5430@cindex section data
5431@cindex output section data
a4d5aec7 5432@kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
252b5132
RH
5433@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5434@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5435@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5436@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5437@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5438You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5439@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5440an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5441parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5442value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5443counter.
5444
5445The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5446store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5447bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5448stored.
5449
5450For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5451of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5452@smallexample
5453BYTE(1)
5454LONG(addr)
5455@end smallexample
5456
5457When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5458same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5459target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5460@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5461@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5462
5463If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5464which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5465When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5466true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5467endianness of the first input object file.
5468
a4d5aec7
AM
5469You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5470@code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5471the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5472end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5473quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5474Hex numbers are not supported.
5475
5476For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5477@smallexample
5478 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5479@end smallexample
5480
36f63dca 5481Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5482between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5483@smallexample
5484SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5485@end smallexample
5486whereas this will work:
5487@smallexample
5488SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5489@end smallexample
75bd292b 5490
252b5132
RH
5491@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5492@cindex holes, filling
5493@cindex unspecified memory
5494You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5495current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5496otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5497gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5498with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5499necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5500point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5501than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5502different parts of an output section.
5503
5504This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5505value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5506@smallexample
563e308f 5507FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5508@end smallexample
5509
5510The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5511section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5512part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5513entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5514precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5515expression.
252b5132 5516
2d5783fa
NC
5517@kindex LINKER_VERSION
5518@cindex LINKER_VERSION
22bfda88
NC
5519The @code{LINKER_VERSION} command inserts a string containing the
5520version of the linker at the current point. Note - by default this
5521directive is disabled and will do nothing. It only becomes active if
5522the @option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
2d5783fa
NC
5523
5524Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5525directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5526
252b5132 5527@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5528@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5529There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5530commands.
5531
5532@table @code
5533@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5534@cindex input filename symbols
5535@cindex filename symbols
5536@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5537The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5538The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5539file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5540the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5541
5542This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5543normally used for any other object file format.
5544
5545@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5546@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5547@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5548@item CONSTRUCTORS
5549When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5550unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5551destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5552arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5553automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5554For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5555linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5556@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5557ignored for other object file formats.
5558
5559The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5560constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5561Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5562the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5563first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5564of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5565compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5566formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5567@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5568the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5569destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5570@code{exit}.
5571
5572For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5573arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5574addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5575and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5576linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5577runtime code expects to see.
5578
5579@smallexample
5580 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5581 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5582 *(.ctors)
5583 LONG(0)
5584 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5585 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5586 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5587 *(.dtors)
5588 LONG(0)
5589 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5590@end smallexample
5591
5592If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5593which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5594are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5595are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5596command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5597@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5598@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5599@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5600
5601Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5602and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5603need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5604scripts.
5605
5606@end table
5607
5608@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5609@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5610@cindex discarding sections
5611@cindex sections, discarding
5612@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5613The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5614This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5615may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5616@smallexample
49c13adb 5617.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5618@end smallexample
5619@noindent
5620will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5621@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5622sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5623space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5624too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5625space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5626@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5627@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5628This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5629
a0976ea4 5630The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5631on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5632symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5633the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5634section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5635
5636@cindex /DISCARD/
5637The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5638input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5639section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5640
99fabbc9
JL
5641This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5642@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5643garbage collection.
5644
a2e098c3
NC
5645Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5646discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5647members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5648Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5649
252b5132 5650@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5651@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5652@cindex output section attributes
5653We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5654like this:
0c71d759 5655
252b5132 5656@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5657@group
7e7d5768 5658@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5659 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5660 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5661 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5662 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5663 @{
5664 @var{output-section-command}
5665 @var{output-section-command}
5666 @dots{}
562d3460 5667 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5668@end group
5669@end smallexample
0c71d759 5670
252b5132
RH
5671We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5672@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5673remaining section attributes.
5674
a1ab1d2a 5675@menu
252b5132
RH
5676* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5677* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5678* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5679* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5680* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5681* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5682* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5683* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5684@end menu
5685
5686@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5687@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5688Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5689parentheses. The following types are defined:
5690
5691@table @code
dcb53d93 5692
252b5132
RH
5693@item NOLOAD
5694The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5695loaded into memory when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5696
6b86da53
LB
5697@item READONLY
5698The section should be marked as read-only.
dcb53d93 5699
252b5132 5700@item DSECT
c212f39d
FS
5701@item COPY
5702@item INFO
5703@item OVERLAY
252b5132
RH
5704These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5705rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5706marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5707section when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5708
c212f39d
FS
5709@item TYPE = @var{type}
5710Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5711output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5c14cc55 5712@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
c212f39d
FS
5713@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5714for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5715special requirements of the section type are met.
dcb53d93
NC
5716
5717Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5718section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5719@smallexample
5720 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5721@end smallexample
5722will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5723@samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5724type. Whereas:
5725@smallexample
5726 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5727@end smallexample
5728will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5729to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5730type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5731@smallexample
5732 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5733@end smallexample
5734
c212f39d
FS
5735@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5736This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5737type specified by @var{type}.
dcb53d93 5738
252b5132
RH
5739@end table
5740
5741@kindex NOLOAD
5742@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5743@cindex loading, preventing
5744The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5745the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5746the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5747@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5748need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5749@smallexample
5750@group
5751SECTIONS @{
5752 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5753 @dots{}
5754@}
5755@end group
5756@end smallexample
5757
5758@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5759@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5760@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5761@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5762@cindex load address
5763@cindex section load address
5764Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5765@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5766@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5767specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5768address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5769
ea5cae92
NC
5770The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5771specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5772takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5773load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5774region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5775
5776If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5777section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5778load address:
5779
5780@itemize @bullet
5781@item
5782If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5783the LMA address as well.
5784
5785@item
5786If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5787
5788@item
5789Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5790with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5791section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5792VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5793the last section in the located region.
5794
5795@item
5796If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5797that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5798
5799@item
5800If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5801section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5802@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5803
5804@cindex ROM initialized data
5805@cindex initialized data in ROM
5806This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5807example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5808called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5809@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5810even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5811uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5812defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5813counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5814
5815@smallexample
5816@group
5817SECTIONS
5818 @{
5819 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5820 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5821 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5822 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5823 .bss 0x3000 :
5824 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5825@}
5826@end group
5827@end smallexample
5828
5829The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5830this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5831the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5832how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5833script.
5834
5835@smallexample
5836@group
5837extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5838char *src = &_etext;
5839char *dst = &_data;
5840
ea5cae92
NC
5841/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5842while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5843 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5844
ea5cae92 5845/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5846for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5847 *dst = 0;
5848@end group
5849@end smallexample
5850
bbf115d3
L
5851@node Forced Output Alignment
5852@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5853@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5854@cindex forcing output section alignment
5855@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5856You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5857alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5858intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5859
7e7d5768
AM
5860@node Forced Input Alignment
5861@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5862@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5863@cindex forcing input section alignment
5864@cindex input section alignment
5865You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5866SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5867sections, whether larger or smaller.
5868
0c71d759
NC
5869@node Output Section Constraint
5870@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5871@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5872@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5873@cindex constraints on output sections
5874You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5875of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5876read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5877@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5878
252b5132 5879@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5880@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5881@kindex >@var{region}
5882@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5883@cindex memory regions and sections
5884You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5885using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5886
5887Here is a simple example:
5888@smallexample
5889@group
5890MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5891SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5892@end group
5893@end smallexample
5894
5895@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5896@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5897@kindex :@var{phdr}
5898@cindex section, assigning to program header
5899@cindex program headers and sections
5900You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5901using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5902one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5903assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5904@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5905linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5906
5907Here is a simple example:
5908@smallexample
5909@group
5910PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5911SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5912@end group
5913@end smallexample
5914
5915@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5916@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5917@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5918@cindex section fill pattern
5919@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5920You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5921@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5922(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5923within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5924alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5925necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5926of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5927an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5928fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5929other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5930pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5931expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5932
5933You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5934output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5935
5936Here is a simple example:
5937@smallexample
5938@group
563e308f 5939SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5940@end group
5941@end smallexample
5942
5943@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5944@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5945@kindex OVERLAY
5946@cindex overlays
5947An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5948are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5949the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5950copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5951required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5952can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5953than another.
5954
5955Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5956@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5957output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5958command is as follows:
5959@smallexample
5960@group
5961OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5962 @{
5963 @var{secname1}
5964 @{
5965 @var{output-section-command}
5966 @var{output-section-command}
5967 @dots{}
5968 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5969 @var{secname2}
5970 @{
5971 @var{output-section-command}
5972 @var{output-section-command}
5973 @dots{}
5974 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5975 @dots{}
abc9061b 5976 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5977@end group
5978@end smallexample
5979
5980Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5981section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5982section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5983those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5984except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5985sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5986
abc9061b
CC
5987The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5988the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5989
252b5132
RH
5990The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5991addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5992memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5993whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5994and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5995and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5996
56dd11f0
NC
5997If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5998references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5999the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
6000sense for one section to refer directly to another.
6001@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
6002
6003For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 6004provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
6005defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
6006@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
6007the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
6008within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
6009symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
6010
6011At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
6012the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
6013
6014Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
6015@code{SECTIONS} construct.
6016@smallexample
6017@group
6018 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6019 @{
6020 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6021 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6022 @}
6023@end group
6024@end smallexample
6025@noindent
6026This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6027address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6028@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 6029following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
6030@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6031@code{__load_stop_text1}.
6032
6033C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6034like the following.
6035
6036@smallexample
6037@group
6038 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6039 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6040 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6041@end group
6042@end smallexample
6043
6044Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6045everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6046example could have been written identically as follows.
6047
6048@smallexample
6049@group
6050 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6051 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6052 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 6053 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6054 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6055 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
6056 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6057@end group
6058@end smallexample
6059
6060@node MEMORY
36f63dca 6061@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
6062@kindex MEMORY
6063@cindex memory regions
6064@cindex regions of memory
6065@cindex allocating memory
6066@cindex discontinuous memory
6067The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6068memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6069
6070The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6071memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6072may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6073can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6074set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6075regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6076around to fit into the available regions.
6077
127fcdff
AB
6078A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6079however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6080specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6081@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
6082@smallexample
6083@group
a1ab1d2a 6084MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6085 @{
6086 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6087 @dots{}
6088 @}
6089@end group
6090@end smallexample
6091
6092The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6093region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6094Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6095with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
6096must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6097add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 6098command.
252b5132
RH
6099
6100@cindex memory region attributes
6101The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6102whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6103not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6104@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6105section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6106the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6107them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6108
6109The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6110@table @samp
6111@item R
6112Read-only section
6113@item W
6114Read/write section
6115@item X
6116Executable section
6117@item A
6118Allocatable section
6119@item I
6120Initialized section
6121@item L
6122Same as @samp{I}
6123@item !
c09e9a8c 6124Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
6125@end table
6126
81c688d5 6127If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 6128@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
6129attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6130unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6131not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6132string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6133or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6134the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
6135
6136@kindex ORIGIN =
6137@kindex o =
6138@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
6139The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6140the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6141cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6142abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6143@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
6144
6145@kindex LENGTH =
6146@kindex len =
6147@kindex l =
6148The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6149region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
6150be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6151@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
6152
6153In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6154available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6155and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6156linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6157is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6158or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6159explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6160region.
6161
6162@smallexample
6163@group
a1ab1d2a 6164MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6165 @{
6166 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6167 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6168 @}
6169@end group
6170@end smallexample
6171
6172Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6173specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6174@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6175a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6176output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6177was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6178the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6179output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6180region, the linker will issue an error message.
6181
3ec57632 6182It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 6183expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
6184@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6185
6186@smallexample
6187@group
c0065db7 6188 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
6189@end group
6190@end smallexample
6191
252b5132
RH
6192@node PHDRS
6193@section PHDRS Command
6194@kindex PHDRS
6195@cindex program headers
6196@cindex ELF program headers
6197@cindex program segments
6198@cindex segments, ELF
6199The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6200@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6201loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6202program with the @samp{-p} option.
6203
6204When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6205reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6206program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6207This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6208interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6209
6210The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6211in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6212precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6213the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6214not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6215
6216The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6217generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6218ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6219
6220This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6221@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6222
6223@smallexample
6224@group
6225PHDRS
6226@{
6227 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6228 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6229@}
6230@end group
6231@end smallexample
6232
6233The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6234of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6235header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6236with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
6237must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6238is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
6239
6240Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6241system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6242specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6243sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6244attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6245Section Phdr}.
6246
6247It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6248merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6249repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6250contain the section.
6251
6252If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6253then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6254not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6255convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6256placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6257default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6258segment at all.
6259
6260@kindex FILEHDR
6261@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6262You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6263the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6264The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6265file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6266include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6267segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6268these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6269
6270The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6271value of the keyword.
6272
6273@table @asis
6274@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6275Indicates an unused program header.
6276
6277@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6278Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6279the file.
6280
6281@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6282Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6283
6284@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6285Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6286found.
6287
6288@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6289Indicates a segment holding note information.
6290
6291@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6292A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6293ABI.
6294
6295@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6296Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6297
1a9ccd70
NC
6298@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6299Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6300
252b5132
RH
6301@item @var{expression}
6302An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6303be used for types not defined above.
6304@end table
6305
6306You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6307in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6308@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6309Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6310output section attribute.
6311
6312The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6313which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6314explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6315an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6316header.
6317
6318Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6319headers used on a native ELF system.
6320
6321@example
6322@group
6323PHDRS
6324@{
6325 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6326 interp PT_INTERP ;
6327 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6328 data PT_LOAD ;
6329 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6330@}
6331
6332SECTIONS
6333@{
6334 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6335 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6336 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6337 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6338 @dots{}
6339 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6340 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6341 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6342 @dots{}
6343@}
6344@end group
6345@end example
6346
6347@node VERSION
6348@section VERSION Command
6349@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6350@cindex symbol versions
6351@cindex version script
6352@cindex versions of symbols
6353The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6354only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6355symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6356a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6357shared library.
6358
6359You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6360you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6361also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6362
6363The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6364@smallexample
6365VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6366@end smallexample
6367
6368The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6369Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6370version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6371version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6372version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6373scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6374library.
6375
6376The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6377examples.
6378
6379@smallexample
6380VERS_1.1 @{
6381 global:
6382 foo1;
6383 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6384 old*;
6385 original*;
6386 new*;
252b5132
RH
6387@};
6388
6389VERS_1.2 @{
6390 foo2;
6391@} VERS_1.1;
6392
6393VERS_2.0 @{
6394 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6395 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6396 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6397 "f(int, double)";
6398 @};
252b5132
RH
6399@} VERS_1.2;
6400@end smallexample
6401
6402This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6403version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6404The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6405a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6406of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6407symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6408is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6409in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6410However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6411name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6412
6413Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6414depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6415to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6416
6417Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6418depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6419and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6420
6421When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6422specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6423unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6424unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6425somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6426wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6427wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6428set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6429ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6430
6431The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6432they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6433could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6434However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6435
0f6bf451 6436Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6437in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6438symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6439won't.
6440
6441@smallexample
7c9c73be 6442@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6443@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6444
252b5132
RH
6445When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6446symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6447requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6448shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6449loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6450linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6451application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6452way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6453all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6454search for each symbol reference.
6455
6456The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6457doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6458that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6459functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6460the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6461required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6462that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6463versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6464the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6465
6466There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6467first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6468source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6469script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6470maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6471@smallexample
6472__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6473@end smallexample
6474@noindent
6475in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6476be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6477The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6478@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6479takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6480
6481The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6482function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6483an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6484version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6485linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6486
6487To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6488source file. Here is an example:
6489
6490@smallexample
6491__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6492__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6493__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6494__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6495@end smallexample
6496
6497In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6498unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6499example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6500@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6501
6502When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6503some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6504this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6505@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6506declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6507you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6508
6509If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6510within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6511(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6512specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6513
cb840a31
L
6514You can also specify the language in the version script:
6515
6516@smallexample
6517VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6518@end smallexample
6519
c0065db7 6520The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6521The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6522demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6523patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6524@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6525
86043bbb
MM
6526Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6527described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6528or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6529the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6530whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6531cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6532might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6533should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6534expect when you upgrade.
6535
252b5132
RH
6536@node Expressions
6537@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6538@cindex expressions
6539@cindex arithmetic
6540The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6541that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6542places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6543evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6544size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6545otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6546
6547You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6548
6549The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6550expressions.
6551
6552@menu
6553* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6554* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6555* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6556* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6557* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6558* Operators:: Operators
6559* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6560* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6561* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6562@end menu
6563
6564@node Constants
6565@subsection Constants
6566@cindex integer notation
6567@cindex constants in linker scripts
6568All constants are integers.
6569
6570As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6571octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6572hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6573@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6574@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6575value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6576
6577@cindex scaled integers
6578@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6579@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6580@cindex suffixes for integers
6581@cindex integer suffixes
6582In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6583constant by
6584@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6585@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6586@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6587@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6588@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6589@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6590@tex
6591${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6592@end tex
6593@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6594respectively. For example, the following
6595all refer to the same quantity:
6596
252b5132 6597@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6598_fourk_1 = 4K;
6599_fourk_2 = 4096;
6600_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6601_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6602@end smallexample
6603
8a308ae8
NC
6604Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6605conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6606
0c71d759
NC
6607@node Symbolic Constants
6608@subsection Symbolic Constants
6609@cindex symbolic constants
6610@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6611It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6612the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6613
6614@table @code
6615@item MAXPAGESIZE
6616@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6617The target's maximum page size.
6618
6619@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6620@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6621The target's default page size.
6622@end table
6623
6624So for example:
6625
6626@smallexample
9d5777a3 6627 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6628@end smallexample
6629
6630will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6631supported by the target.
6632
252b5132
RH
6633@node Symbols
6634@subsection Symbol Names
6635@cindex symbol names
6636@cindex names
6637@cindex quoted symbol names
6638@kindex "
6639Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6640and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6641Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6642specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6643keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6644@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6645"SECTION" = 9;
6646"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6647@end smallexample
6648
6649Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6650to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6651whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6652
ecca9871
L
6653@node Orphan Sections
6654@subsection Orphan Sections
6655@cindex orphan
6656Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6657are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6658script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6659output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6660in which to place the orphaned input section.
6661
6662If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6663an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6664placed at the end of that output section.
6665
6666If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6667sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6668name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6669orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6670one new output section.
6671
6672If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6673then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6674in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6675linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6676attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6677sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6678support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6679
a05a5b64
TP
6680The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6681(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6682output sections an orphan is placed in.
6683
252b5132
RH
6684@node Location Counter
6685@subsection The Location Counter
6686@kindex .
6687@cindex dot
6688@cindex location counter
6689@cindex current output location
6690The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6691current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6692location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6693within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6694anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6695
6696@cindex holes
6697Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6698moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6699location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6700and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6701doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6702
6703@smallexample
6704SECTIONS
6705@{
6706 output :
6707 @{
6708 file1(.text)
6709 . = . + 1000;
6710 file2(.text)
6711 . += 1000;
6712 file3(.text)
563e308f 6713 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6714@}
6715@end smallexample
6716@noindent
6717In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6718located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6719followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6720@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6721@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6722specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6723
5c6bbab8
NC
6724@cindex dot inside sections
6725Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6726current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6727statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6728absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6729however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6730not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6731
6732@smallexample
6733SECTIONS
6734@{
6735 . = 0x100
6736 .text: @{
6737 *(.text)
6738 . = 0x200
6739 @}
6740 . = 0x500
6741 .data: @{
6742 *(.data)
6743 . += 0x600
6744 @}
6745@}
6746@end smallexample
6747
6748The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6749and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6750the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6751much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6752move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6753and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6754the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6755the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6756
b5666f2f
AM
6757@cindex dot outside sections
6758Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6759output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6760needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6761
6762@smallexample
6763SECTIONS
6764@{
6765 start_of_text = . ;
6766 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6767 end_of_text = . ;
6768
6769 start_of_data = . ;
6770 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6771 end_of_data = . ;
6772@}
6773@end smallexample
6774
6775If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6776not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6777between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6778should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6779blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6780the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6781sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6782statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6783special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6784place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6785as follows:
6786
6787@smallexample
6788SECTIONS
6789@{
6790 start_of_text = . ;
6791 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6792 end_of_text = . ;
6793
6794 start_of_data = . ;
6795 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6796 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6797 end_of_data = . ;
6798@}
6799@end smallexample
6800
6801This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6802@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6803placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6804assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6805a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6806section. So you could write:
6807
6808@smallexample
6809SECTIONS
6810@{
6811 start_of_text = . ;
6812 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6813 end_of_text = . ;
6814
6815 . = . ;
6816 start_of_data = . ;
6817 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6818 end_of_data = . ;
6819@}
6820@end smallexample
6821
6822Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6823@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6824
252b5132
RH
6825@need 2000
6826@node Operators
6827@subsection Operators
6828@cindex operators for arithmetic
6829@cindex arithmetic operators
6830@cindex precedence in expressions
6831The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6832the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6833@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6834@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6835@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6836@smallexample
b5c37946 6837precedence associativity Operators Notes
252b5132 6838(highest)
b5c37946 68391 left ! - ~ (1)
252b5132
RH
68402 left * / %
68413 left + -
68424 left >> <<
b5c37946
SJ
68435 left > < <= >=
68446 left == !=
68457 left &
68468 left ^
68479 left |
684810 left &&
684911 left ||
685012 right ? :
685113 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
252b5132
RH
6852(lowest)
6853@end smallexample
6854Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6855(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6856(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6857@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6858@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6859@tex
6860\vskip \baselineskip
6861%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6862\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6863\hrule
6864\halign
6865{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6866height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6867&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6868height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6869\noalign{\hrule}
6870height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6871&highest&&&&&\cr
6872% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6873&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6874&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6875&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6876&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
b5c37946
SJ
6877&5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
6878&6&&left&&== !=&\cr
6879&7&&left&&\&&\cr
6880&8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
6881&9&&left&&|&\cr
6882&10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6883&11&&left&&||&\cr
6884&12&&right&&? :&\cr
6885&13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6886&lowest&&&&&\cr
6887height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6888\hrule}
6889@end tex
6890@iftex
6891{
6892@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6893@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6894@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6895}
6896@end iftex
6897@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6898
6899@node Evaluation
6900@subsection Evaluation
6901@cindex lazy evaluation
6902@cindex expression evaluation order
6903The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6904an expression when absolutely necessary.
6905
6906The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6907address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6908regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6909as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6910
6911However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6912until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6913other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6914for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6915
6916The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6917assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6918allocation.
6919
6920Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6921@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6922
6923If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6924available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6925following
6926@smallexample
6927@group
6928SECTIONS
6929 @{
a1ab1d2a 6930 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6931 @{ *(.text) @}
6932 @}
6933@end group
6934@end smallexample
6935@noindent
6936will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6937address}.
6938
6939@node Expression Section
6940@subsection The Section of an Expression
6941@cindex expression sections
6942@cindex absolute expressions
6943@cindex relative expressions
6944@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6945@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6946@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6947Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6948relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6949using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6950value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6951symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6952operations.
6953
abf4be64
AM
6954Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6955section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6956address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6957@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6958functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6959One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6960(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6961differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6962versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6963section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6964Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6965absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6966given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6967everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6968
6969In the following simple example,
252b5132 6970
7542af2a
AM
6971@smallexample
6972@group
6973SECTIONS
6974 @{
6975 . = 0x100;
6976 __executable_start = 0x100;
6977 .data :
6978 @{
6979 . = 0x10;
6980 __data_start = 0x10;
6981 *(.data)
6982 @}
6983 @dots{}
6984 @}
6985@end group
6986@end smallexample
252b5132 6987
7542af2a
AM
6988both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6989address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6990@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6991section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6992
5c3049d2
AM
6993For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6994addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6995
6996@itemize @bullet
6997@item
c05f749e
AM
6998Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6999operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
7000absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
7001@item
7542af2a
AM
7002Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
7003relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
7004and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
7005@item
c05f749e
AM
7006Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
7007in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
7008address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
7009before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
7010@end itemize
7011
7012The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
7013
7014@itemize @bullet
7015@item
7016An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7017@item
7018The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7019@item
9bc8bb33 7020The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 7021relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
7022(after above conversions) is also a number when
7023@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7024but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
7025@item
7026The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7027relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7028section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
7029@item
7030The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7031conversions) is an absolute address.
7032@end itemize
252b5132
RH
7033
7034You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7035to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7036create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7037section @samp{.data}:
7038@smallexample
7039SECTIONS
7040 @{
7041 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7042 @}
7043@end smallexample
7044@noindent
7045If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7046@samp{.data} section.
7047
7542af2a
AM
7048Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7049particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7050
252b5132
RH
7051@node Builtin Functions
7052@subsection Builtin Functions
7053@cindex functions in expressions
7054The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7055use in linker script expressions.
7056
7057@table @code
7058@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7059@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7060@cindex expression, absolute
7061Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7062of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7063value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7064normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7065
7066@item ADDR(@var{section})
7067@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7068@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 7069Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 7070script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
7071the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7072@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7073@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7074the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
7075@smallexample
7076@group
7077SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7078 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 7079 @{
252b5132
RH
7080 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7081 @dots{}
7082 @}
7083 .output :
7084 @{
7085 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7086 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7087 @}
7088@dots{} @}
7089@end group
7090@end smallexample
7091
876f4090
NS
7092@item ALIGN(@var{align})
7093@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7094@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7095@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
7096@cindex round up location counter
7097@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
7098@cindex round up expression
7099@cindex align expression
7100Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7101to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7102doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7103arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7104expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 7105equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
7106
7107Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7108next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7109variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7110input sections:
252b5132
RH
7111@smallexample
7112@group
7113SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7114 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7115 *(.data)
7116 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7117 @}
7118@dots{} @}
7119@end group
7120@end smallexample
7121@noindent
7122The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7123a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7124a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7125of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7126
7127The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7128
362c1d1a
NS
7129@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7130@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7131@cindex section alignment
7132Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
b5c37946
SJ
7133been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7134section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7135error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7136return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7137linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7138example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7139first value in that section.
362c1d1a
NS
7140@smallexample
7141@group
7142SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7143 .output @{
7144 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7145 @dots{}
7146 @}
7147@dots{} @}
7148@end group
7149@end smallexample
7150
252b5132
RH
7151@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7152@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7153This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7154scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7155section.
7156
2d20f7bf
JJ
7157@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7158@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7159This is equivalent to either
7160@smallexample
7161(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7162@end smallexample
7163or
7164@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
7165(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7166 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
7167@end smallexample
7168@noindent
7169depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7170for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7171@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7172If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7173memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7174bytes in the on-disk file.
7175
7176This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7177any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7178@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
7179be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7180running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7181that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7182page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
7183
7184@noindent
7185Example:
7186@smallexample
7187 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7188@end smallexample
7189
7190@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7191@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7192This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7193evaluation purposes.
7194
7195@smallexample
7196 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7197@end smallexample
7198
a4f5ad88
JJ
7199@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7200@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7201This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 7202@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7203When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7204does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
7205@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7206argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7207script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
7208@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7209padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7210section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7211
7212@smallexample
7213 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7214@end smallexample
7215
252b5132
RH
7216@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7217@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7218@cindex symbol defaults
7219Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
7220defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7221return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
7222default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7223shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7224the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7225existed, its value is preserved:
7226
7227@smallexample
7228@group
7229SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7230 .text : @{
7231 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7232 @dots{}
7233 @}
7234 @dots{}
7235@}
7236@end group
7237@end smallexample
7238
3ec57632
NC
7239@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7240@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7241Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7242
252b5132
RH
7243@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7244@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7245@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 7246Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
7247Section LMA}).
7248
2e53f7d6
NC
7249@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7250@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7251Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7252@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7253
252b5132
RH
7254@kindex MAX
7255@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7256Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7257
7258@kindex MIN
7259@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7260Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7261
7262@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7263@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7264@cindex unallocated address, next
7265Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7266This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7267use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7268output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7269
3ec57632
NC
7270@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7271@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7272Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7273
ba916c8a
MM
7274@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7275@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7276Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7277value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7278@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7279will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7280can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7281``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7282name.
7283
252b5132
RH
7284@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7285@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7286@cindex section size
7287Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
b5c37946
SJ
7288been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7289section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7290error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7291return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7292linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7293example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7294values:
252b5132
RH
7295@smallexample
7296@group
7297SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7298 .output @{
7299 .start = . ;
7300 @dots{}
7301 .end = . ;
7302 @}
7303 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7304 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7305@dots{} @}
7306@end group
7307@end smallexample
7308
7309@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7310@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7311@cindex header size
7312Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7313information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7314this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7315choose, to facilitate paging.
7316
7317@cindex not enough room for program headers
7318@cindex program headers, not enough room
7319When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7320@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7321number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7322addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7323additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7324room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7325the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7326script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7327you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7328command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7329@end table
7330
7331@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7332@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7333@cindex implicit linker scripts
7334If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7335an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7336linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7337linker will report an error.
7338
7339An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7340
7341Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7342assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7343commands.
7344
7345Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7346at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7347read. This can affect archive searching.
7348
bf6d8037
HC
7349@node Plugins
7350@chapter Linker Plugins
7351
7352@cindex plugins
7353@cindex linker plugins
7354The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7355For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7356support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7357
7358Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7359be added here later.
7360
9b38b85e 7361Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
3a117c58 7362command line option. @xref{Options}.
9b38b85e 7363
bf6d8037
HC
7364@menu
7365* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7366@end menu
7367
7368@node libdep Plugin
7369@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7370@cindex static library dependencies
7371Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7372just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7373optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7374within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7375rose to ascendance.
7376
7377One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7378multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7379dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7380library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7381referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7382link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7383libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7384explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7385
7386The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7387to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7388plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7389dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7390and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7391command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7392utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7393being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7394archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7395
7396For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7397library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7398the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7399
7400@smallexample
7401-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7402@end smallexample
7403
252b5132
RH
7404@ifset GENERIC
7405@node Machine Dependent
7406@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7407
7408@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7409@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7410sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7411functionality are not listed.
7412
7413@menu
36f63dca
NC
7414@ifset H8300
7415* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7416@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7417@ifset M68HC11
7418* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7419@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7420@ifset ARM
7421* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7422@end ifset
7423@ifset HPPA
7424* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7425@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7426@ifset M68K
7427* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7428@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7429@ifset MIPS
7430* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7431@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7432@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7433* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7434@end ifset
2469cfa2 7435@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7436* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7437@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7438@ifset NDS32
7439* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7440@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7441@ifset NIOSII
7442* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7443@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7444@ifset POWERPC
7445* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7446@end ifset
7447@ifset POWERPC64
7448* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7449@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7450@ifset S/390
7451* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7452@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7453@ifset SPU
7454* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7455@end ifset
74459f0e 7456@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7457* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7458@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7459@ifset WIN32
7460* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7461@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7462@ifset XTENSA
7463* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7464@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7465@end menu
7466@end ifset
7467
252b5132
RH
7468@ifset H8300
7469@ifclear GENERIC
7470@raisesections
7471@end ifclear
7472
7473@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7474@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7475
7476@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7477For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7478you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7479
7480@table @emph
7481@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7482@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7483@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7484targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7485program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7486respectively.
7487
7488@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7489@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7490@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7491@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7492sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7493page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7494(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7495@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7496top page of memory).
1502569c 7497
81f5558e
NC
7498@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7499indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7500displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7501the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7502@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7503whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7504range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7505
1502569c 7506@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7507@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7508biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7509which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7510page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7511(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7512@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7513the top page of memory).
7514
7515@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7516@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
751732 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7518changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7519(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7520@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7521the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7522@end table
7523
7524@ifclear GENERIC
7525@lowersections
7526@end ifclear
7527@end ifset
7528
36f63dca 7529@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7530@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7531@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7532@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7533@node Renesas
7534@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7535
c2dcd04e
NC
7536@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7537H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7538options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7539@end ifset
7540@end ifclear
7541
36f63dca
NC
7542@ifset ARM
7543@ifclear GENERIC
7544@raisesections
7545@end ifclear
7546
93fd0973
SC
7547@ifset M68HC11
7548@ifclear GENERIC
7549@raisesections
7550@end ifclear
7551
7552@node M68HC11/68HC12
7553@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7554
7555@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7556
7557@subsection Linker Relaxation
7558
7559For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7560optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7561
7562@table @emph
7563@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7564@item relaxing address modes
7565@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7566targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7567program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7568respectively.
7569
7570@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7571transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7572page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7573
7574@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7575When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7576of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7577addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7578@code{bset} instructions.
7579
7580@end table
7581
7582@subsection Trampoline Generation
7583
7584@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7585@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7586For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7587call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7588will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7589trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7590case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7591point to the function trampoline.
7592
7593@ifclear GENERIC
7594@lowersections
7595@end ifclear
7596@end ifset
7597
36f63dca 7598@node ARM
3674e28a 7599@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7600
7601@cindex ARM interworking support
7602@kindex --support-old-code
7603For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7604between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7605been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7606line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7607libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7608option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7609given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7610which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7611the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7612non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7613
7614@cindex thumb entry point
7615@cindex entry point, thumb
7616@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7617The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7618@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7619But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7620branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7621executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7622
ce11ba6c
KT
7623@cindex PE import table prefixing
7624@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7625The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7626the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7627element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7628import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7629
e489d0ae
PB
7630@cindex BE8
7631@kindex --be8
7632The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7633executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7634objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7635option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7636little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7637
3674e28a
PB
7638@cindex TARGET1
7639@kindex --target1-rel
7640@kindex --target1-abs
7641The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7642@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7643or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7644and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7645
7646@cindex TARGET2
7647@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7648The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7649@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7650meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7651@table @samp
7652@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7653@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7654@item abs
a57d1773 7655@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7656@item got-rel
7657@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7658@end table
7659
319850b4
JB
7660@cindex FIX_V4BX
7661@kindex --fix-v4bx
7662The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7663specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7664interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7665also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7666
7667In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7668linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7669@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7670
7671In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7672relocations are ignored.
7673
845b51d6
PB
7674@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7675@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7676Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7677relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7678
7679@smallexample
7680TST rM, #1
7681MOVEQ PC, rM
7682BX Rn
7683@end smallexample
7684
7685This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7686and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7687condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7688
33bfe774
JB
7689@cindex USE_BLX
7690@kindex --use-blx
7691The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7692BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7693situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7694code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7695each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7696
c6dd86c6
JB
7697@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7698@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7699The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7700bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7701instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7702to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7703the support code can read the intended values.
7704
7705The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7706intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7707and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7708intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7709full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7710you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7711
7712If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7713enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7714@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7715mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7716vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7717@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7718
7719If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7720potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7721such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7722first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7723instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7724the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7725are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7726
2de70689
MGD
7727@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7728@kindex --fix-arm1176
7729@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7730The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7731in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7732are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7733unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7734
9d5777a3 7735Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7736Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7737http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7738
a504d23a
LA
7739@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7740@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7741
7742The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7743workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7744the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7745off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7746the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7747core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7748integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7749VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7750
7751The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7752necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7753
7754The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7755@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7756STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7757linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7758@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7759
7760If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7761potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7762such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7763replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7764branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7765then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7766
7767The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7768the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7769
7770The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7771they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7772there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7773occurs.
7774
7775The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7776PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7777large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7778cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7779occurs.
7780
bf21ed78
MS
7781@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7782@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7783The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7784warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7785enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7786linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7787using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7788not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7789
7790@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7791@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7792The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7793warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7794@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7795linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7796using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7797
726150b7
NC
7798@cindex PIC_VENEER
7799@kindex --pic-veneer
7800The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7801ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7802is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7803@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7804
7805@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7806@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7807The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7808code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7809perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7810placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7811controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7812The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7813duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7814group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7815code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7816where they should be placed.
7817
7818The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7819@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7820placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7821branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7822placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7823value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7824exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7825A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7826linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7827from the input sections.
7828
7829The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7830@samp{N = +1}.
7831
1a51c1a4
NC
7832Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7833only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7834otherwise.
7835
1db37fe6
YG
7836@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7837@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7838@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7839The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7840
7841The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7842
68fcca92
JW
7843@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7844@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7845@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7846The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7847
7848Please contact ARM for further details.
7849
1db37fe6
YG
7850@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7851@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7852@cindex Merging exidx entries
7853The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7854
7855@kindex --long-plt
7856@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7857The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7858which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7859entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7860
1f56df9d
JW
7861@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7862@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7863The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7864link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7865
4ba2ef8f
TP
7866@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7867All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7868Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7869@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7870veneers in memory.
7871
54ddd295
TP
7872@kindex --cmse-implib
7873@cindex Secure gateway import library
7874The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7875specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7876secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7877executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7878
0955507f
TP
7879@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7880@cindex Input import library
7881The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7882must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7883given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7884in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7885@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7886library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7887library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7888for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7889specified.
7890
36f63dca
NC
7891@ifclear GENERIC
7892@lowersections
7893@end ifclear
7894@end ifset
7895
7896@ifset HPPA
7897@ifclear GENERIC
7898@raisesections
7899@end ifclear
7900
7901@node HPPA ELF32
7902@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7903@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7904@kindex --multi-subspace
7905When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7906import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7907The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7908stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7909multiple sub-spaces.
7910
7911@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7912@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7913Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7914stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7915@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7916sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7917a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7918the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7919conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7920prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7921A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7922branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7923@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7924@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7925detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7926positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7927
7928Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7929single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7930create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7931large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7932
7933@ifclear GENERIC
7934@lowersections
7935@end ifclear
7936@end ifset
7937
7fb9f789
NC
7938@ifset M68K
7939@ifclear GENERIC
7940@raisesections
7941@end ifclear
7942
7943@node M68K
7944@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7945
7946@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7947@kindex --got=@var{type}
7948The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7949The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7950@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7951the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7952@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7953entries only at non-negative offsets.
7954@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7955entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7956support such GOTs.
7957@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7958output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7959file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7960files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7961
7962@ifclear GENERIC
7963@lowersections
7964@end ifclear
7965@end ifset
7966
833794fc
MR
7967@ifset MIPS
7968@ifclear GENERIC
7969@raisesections
7970@end ifclear
7971
7972@node MIPS
7973@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7974
7975@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7976@kindex --insn32
7977@kindex --no-insn32
7978The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7979microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7980in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7981used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7982or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7983including 16-bit ones where possible.
7984
8b10b0b3
MR
7985@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7986@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7987@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7988The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7989control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7990@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7991relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7992calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7993relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7994instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7995or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7996the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7997
833794fc
MR
7998@ifclear GENERIC
7999@lowersections
8000@end ifclear
8001@end ifset
8002
36f63dca
NC
8003@ifset MMIX
8004@ifclear GENERIC
8005@raisesections
8006@end ifclear
8007
8008@node MMIX
8009@section @code{ld} and MMIX
8010For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
8011@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
8012understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
8013can translate between the two formats.
8014
8015There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8016Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8017registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8018equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8019@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8020global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8021this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8022symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8023
7a2de473
HPN
8024Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8025@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8026The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8027of a section.
36f63dca
NC
8028
8029Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8030are left out from an mmo file.
8031
8032@ifclear GENERIC
8033@lowersections
8034@end ifclear
8035@end ifset
8036
8037@ifset MSP430
8038@ifclear GENERIC
8039@raisesections
8040@end ifclear
8041
8042@node MSP430
8043@section @code{ld} and MSP430
8044For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8045will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8046just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8047
8048@cindex MSP430 extra sections
8049The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8050
8051@table @code
8052@item @samp{.vectors}
8053Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8054
8055@item @samp{.bootloader}
8056Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8057in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8058
8059@item @samp{.infomem}
8060Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8061this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8062
c0065db7 8063@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
8064This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8065in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8066
8067@item @samp{.noinit}
8068Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8069
c0065db7 8070The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
8071@end table
8072
7ef3addb
JL
8073@table @option
8074@cindex MSP430 Options
8075@kindex --code-region
8076@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8077This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8078argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8079using this option.
8080
8081@kindex --data-region
8082@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8083This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8084[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8085for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8086
8087@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8088@item --disable-sec-transformation
8089Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8090and @code{--data-region} options.
8091This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8092wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8093not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8094@end table
8095
36f63dca
NC
8096@ifclear GENERIC
8097@lowersections
8098@end ifclear
8099@end ifset
8100
35c08157
KLC
8101@ifset NDS32
8102@ifclear GENERIC
8103@raisesections
8104@end ifclear
8105
8106@node NDS32
8107@section @code{ld} and NDS32
8108@kindex relaxing on NDS32
8109For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8110relaxes objects according to these options.
8111
8112@table @code
8113@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8114Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8115
8116@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8117Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8118
8119@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8120Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8121
8122@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8123Export the EX9 table after linking.
8124
8125@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8126Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8127
8128@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8129Update the existing EX9 table.
8130
8131@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8132Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8133
8134@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8135Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8136
8137@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8138Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8139
8140@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8141Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8142@end table
8143
8144@ifclear GENERIC
8145@lowersections
8146@end ifclear
8147@end ifset
8148
78058a5e
SL
8149@ifset NIOSII
8150@ifclear GENERIC
8151@raisesections
8152@end ifclear
8153
8154@node Nios II
8155@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8156@cindex Nios II call relaxation
8157@kindex --relax on Nios II
8158
8159Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8160transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8161which may result in @command{ld} giving
8162@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8163The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8164trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8165outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8166trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8167be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8168larger than 256MB.
8169
8170The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8171is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8172@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8173locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8174source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8175register as a temporary.
8176
8177Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8178relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8179option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8180
8181@ifclear GENERIC
8182@lowersections
8183@end ifclear
8184@end ifset
8185
2a60a7a8
AM
8186@ifset POWERPC
8187@ifclear GENERIC
8188@raisesections
8189@end ifclear
8190
8191@node PowerPC ELF32
8192@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8193@cindex PowerPC long branches
8194@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8195Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8196displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8197@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8198@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8199the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8200section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
8201section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8202@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8203both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8204considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
8205
8206@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8207@table @option
8208@cindex PowerPC PLT
8209@kindex --bss-plt
8210@item --bss-plt
8211Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8212generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8213the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8214writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8215@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8216PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8217compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8218BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8219
016687f8
AM
8220@kindex --secure-plt
8221@item --secure-plt
8222@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8223@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8224when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8225layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8226style BSS PLT.
8227
2a60a7a8
AM
8228@cindex PowerPC GOT
8229@kindex --sdata-got
8230@item --sdata-got
8231The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8232sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8233@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8234section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8235@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8236@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8237@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8238@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8239PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8240pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8241GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8242really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8243
8244@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8245@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8246@item --emit-stub-syms
8247This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8248symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8249
8250@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8251@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8252@item --no-tls-optimize
8253PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8254sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8255disable the optimization.
8256@end table
8257
8258@ifclear GENERIC
8259@lowersections
8260@end ifclear
8261@end ifset
8262
8263@ifset POWERPC64
8264@ifclear GENERIC
8265@raisesections
8266@end ifclear
8267
8268@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8269@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8270
8271@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8272@table @option
8273@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8274@kindex --stub-group-size
8275@item --stub-group-size
8276Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8277by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8278@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8279sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8280a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8281the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8282conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8283prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8284A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8285branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8286@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8287@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8288detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8289positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8290
8291Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8292single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8293create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8294large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8295
8296@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8297@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8298@item --emit-stub-syms
8299This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8300symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8301
8302@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8303@kindex --dotsyms
8304@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8305@item --dotsyms
8306@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8307These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8308in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8309function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8310code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8311properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8312to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8313@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8314dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8315feature.
8316
7ae4ea7d
AM
8317@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8318@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8319@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8320@item --save-restore-funcs
8321@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8322These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8323provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8324@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8325function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8326link.
8327
2a60a7a8
AM
8328@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8329@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8330@item --no-tls-optimize
8331PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8332sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8333disable the optimization.
8334
7c9cf415
AM
8335@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8336@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8337@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8338@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8339@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8340@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8341@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8342These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8343stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8344an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8345@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8346stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8347generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8348__tls_get_addr_opt.
8349Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8350much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8351an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8352will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8353@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8354and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8355this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8356Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8357@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8358register saves.
7c9cf415 8359
2a60a7a8
AM
8360@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8361@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8362@item --no-opd-optimize
8363PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8364corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8365the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8366Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8367
8368@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8369@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8370@item --non-overlapping-opd
8371Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8372@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8373the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8374entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8375
8376@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8377@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8378@item --no-toc-optimize
8379PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8380entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8381reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8382marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8383marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8384relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8385unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8386reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8387discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8388reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8389code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8390optimization.
8391
d882c988
AM
8392@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8393@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8394@item --no-inline-optimize
8395PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8396marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8397@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8398a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8399locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8400disables that optimization.
8401
2a60a7a8
AM
8402@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8403@kindex --no-multi-toc
8404@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8405If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8406@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8407where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8408entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8409total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8410grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8411TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8412calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8413help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
841464K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8415Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8416
8417@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8418@kindex --no-toc-sort
8419@item --no-toc-sort
8420By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8421happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8422placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8423with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8424referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8425@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8426results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8427off this feature.
8428
8429@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8430@kindex --plt-align
8431@kindex --no-plt-align
8432@item --plt-align
8433@itemx --no-plt-align
8434Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8435aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8436boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8437specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8438specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8439if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8440PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8441
8442@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8443@kindex --plt-static-chain
8444@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8445@item --plt-static-chain
8446@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8447Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8448chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8449chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8450
8451@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8452@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8453@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8454@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8455@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8456With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8457lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8458another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8459order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8460memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8461barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8462looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8463seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8464default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8465
8466@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8467@kindex --plt-localentry
8468@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8469@item --plt-localentry
8470@itemx --no-localentry
8471ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8472ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8473(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8474Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8475or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8476functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8477in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8478interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8479including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8480to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8481complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8482care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8483
8484@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8485@kindex --power10-stubs
8486@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8487@item --power10-stubs
8488@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8489When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8490relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8491linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8492for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8493power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8494power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8495allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8496@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8497auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8498@end table
8499
8500@ifclear GENERIC
8501@lowersections
8502@end ifclear
8503@end ifset
8504
b4cbbe8f
AK
8505@ifset S/390
8506@ifclear GENERIC
8507@raisesections
8508@end ifclear
8509
8510@node S/390 ELF
8511@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8512
8513@cindex S/390 ELF options
8514@table @option
8515
8516@cindex S/390
8517@kindex --s390-pgste
8518@item --s390-pgste
8519This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8520segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8521binaries marked that way.
8522@end table
8523
8524@ifclear GENERIC
8525@lowersections
8526@end ifclear
8527@end ifset
8528
49fa1e15
AM
8529@ifset SPU
8530@ifclear GENERIC
8531@raisesections
8532@end ifclear
8533
8534@node SPU ELF
8535@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8536
8537@cindex SPU ELF options
8538@table @option
8539
8540@cindex SPU plugins
8541@kindex --plugin
8542@item --plugin
8543This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8544
8545@cindex SPU overlays
8546@kindex --no-overlays
8547@item --no-overlays
8548Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8549regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8550@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8551turns off all this special overlay handling.
8552
8553@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8554@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8555@item --emit-stub-syms
8556This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8557symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8558
8559@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8560@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8561@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8562This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8563function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8564on calls to non-overlay regions.
8565
8566@cindex SPU local store size
8567@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8568@item --local-store=lo:hi
8569@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8570the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8571range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8572
c0065db7 8573@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8574@kindex --stack-analysis
8575@item --stack-analysis
8576SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8577unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8578under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8579@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8580@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8581determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8582for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8583for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8584for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8585find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8586and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8587under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8588dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8589is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8590and calls will be given.
8591
c0065db7 8592@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8593@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8594@item --emit-stack-syms
8595This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8596in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8597These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8598functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8599functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8600such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8601The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8602@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8603@end table
8604
8605@ifclear GENERIC
8606@lowersections
8607@end ifclear
8608@end ifset
8609
36f63dca
NC
8610@ifset TICOFF
8611@ifclear GENERIC
8612@raisesections
8613@end ifclear
8614
8615@node TI COFF
8616@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8617@cindex TI COFF versions
8618@kindex --format=@var{version}
8619The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8620TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8621also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8622format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8623header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8624
8625@ifclear GENERIC
8626@lowersections
8627@end ifclear
8628@end ifset
8629
2ca22b03
NC
8630@ifset WIN32
8631@ifclear GENERIC
8632@raisesections
8633@end ifclear
8634
8635@node WIN32
8636@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8637
c0065db7 8638This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8639See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8640command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8641
8642@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8643@cindex import libraries
8644@item import libraries
69da35b5 8645The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8646libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8647regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8648archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8649support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8650@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8651
d1792f72
NC
8652@item Resource only DLLs
8653It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8654@samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8655must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
05d31a0b 8656will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
d1792f72
NC
8657there is no input to go into them.
8658
8659The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8660should be changed to match the desired format.
8661
8662@example
8663OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8664SECTIONS
8665@{
8666 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8667 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8668 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8669 @{
8670 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8671 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8672 @}
8673 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8674@}
8675@end example
8676
8677With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8678line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8679@file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8680
8681@smallexample
8682ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8683@end smallexample
8684
c0065db7
RM
8685@item exporting DLL symbols
8686@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8687The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8688
8689@table @emph
8690@item using auto-export functionality
8691@cindex using auto-export functionality
8692By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8693which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8694
0a5d968e
NC
8695@itemize
8696@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8697@item --exclude-symbols
8698@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8699@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8700@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8701@end itemize
8702
09e2aba4
DK
8703When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8704(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8705symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8706often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8707private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8708options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8709exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8710final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8711
8712If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8713command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8714if either of the following are true:
8715
8716@itemize
8717@item A DEF file is used.
8718@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8719@end itemize
dc8465bf 8720
c0065db7
RM
8721@item using a DEF file
8722@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8723Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8724an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8725exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8726name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8727command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8728
8729@example
8730gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8731@end example
8732
0a5d968e
NC
8733Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8734@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8735
dc8465bf
NC
8736Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8737
8738@example
4b5bd4e7 8739LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8740
8741EXPORTS
8742foo
8743bar
8744_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8745another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8746var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8747doo = foo == foo2
8748eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8749@end example
dc8465bf 8750
7fcab871 8751This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8752symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8753alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8754by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8755@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8756@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8757export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8758in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8759symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8760
6b31ad16
DS
8761The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8762name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8763the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8764
b45619c0
NC
8765When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8766library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8767@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8768executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8769
8770With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8771specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8772non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8773
8774If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8775or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8776filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8777
4b5bd4e7
DS
8778The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8779
8780@example
8781EXPORTS
8782 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8783 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8784 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8785@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8786
8787Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8788@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8789@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8790@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8791Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8792@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8793string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8794
8795The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8796
8797@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8798will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8799by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8800linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8801library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8802
8803@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8804The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8805the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8806@code{*_imp__foo}).
8807
8808@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8809well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8810read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8811variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8812the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8813extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8814application will behave unexpectedly.
8815
8816@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8817it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8818symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8819API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8820the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8821
4b5bd4e7
DS
8822See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8823other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8824
8825@cindex creating a DEF file
8826While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8827with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8828
8829@item Using decorations
8830@cindex Using decorations
8831Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8832itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8833declared as:
8834
8835@example
8836__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8837__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8838@end example
8839
8840All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8841any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8842this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8843the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8844
8845Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8846decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8847instead:
8848
8849@example
8850__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8851__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8852@end example
8853
c0065db7
RM
8854This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8855when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8856variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8857code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8858of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8859omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8860@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8861information.
c0065db7 8862@end table
dc8465bf 8863
2ca22b03
NC
8864@cindex automatic data imports
8865@item automatic data imports
8866The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8867by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8868compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8869issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8870code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8871c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8872initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8873decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8874platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8875command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8876The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8877suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8878trigger the feature's use.
8879
c0065db7 8880auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8881additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8882
c0065db7 8883"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8884documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8885
c0065db7
RM
8886The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8887occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8888One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8889below.
8890
8891@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8892For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8893object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8894offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8895field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8896in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8897without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8898The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8899references.
8900
c0065db7
RM
8901The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8902be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8903themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8904runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8905compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8906support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8907run without error on an older system.
8908
c0065db7
RM
8909@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8910enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8911
8912@cindex direct linking to a dll
8913@item direct linking to a dll
8914The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8915including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8916libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8917traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8918libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8919function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8920though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8921storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8922tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8923large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8924
c0065db7 8925Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8926@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8927of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8928perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8929select the dll instead of an import library.
8930
2ca22b03 8931
69da35b5
NC
8932For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8933to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8934
8935@example
45e948fe
NC
8936libxxx.dll.a
8937xxx.dll.a
8938libxxx.a
8939xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8940libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8941cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8942libxxx.dll
8943xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8944@end example
8945
69da35b5
NC
8946before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8947
c0065db7
RM
8948(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8949where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8950@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8951file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8952@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8953
c0065db7
RM
8954Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8955@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8956was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8957various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8958could coexist on the same machine.
8959
2ca22b03
NC
8960The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8961applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8962libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8963
8964@example
8965bin/
8966 cygxxx.dll
8967lib/
8968 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8969 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8970@end example
8971
c0065db7
RM
8972Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8973done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8974
89751. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8976@example
8977gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8978@end example
2ca22b03 8979
69da35b5
NC
8980However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8981(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8982@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8983not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8984
2ca22b03
NC
89852. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8986directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8987should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8988making the app/dll.
8989
8990@example
8991ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8992@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8993
8994Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8995
8996@example
8997gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8998@end example
69da35b5
NC
8999
9000This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
9001perfectly legal
9002
9003@example
9004bin/
9005 cygxxx-5.dll
9006lib/
c0065db7 9007 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
9008@end example
9009
dc8465bf 9010Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
9011even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
9012@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
9013
9014Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 9015wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
9016
90171. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9018work with auto-imported data.
9019
dc8465bf
NC
90202. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9021import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9022symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9023for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9024possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 9025
45e948fe
NC
90263. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9027critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9028in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9029stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9030
69da35b5 9031So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
9032true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9033a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9034binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
9035massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9036requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9037will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 9038
c0065db7 9039@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 9040@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
9041@item adding additional names
9042Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
9043A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9044exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9045when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 9046import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 9047
c0065db7 9048@example
dc8465bf
NC
9049LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9050
9051EXPORTS
c0065db7 9052foo
dc8465bf 9053_foo = foo
c0065db7 9054@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9055
9056The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9057
9058Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9059source code using the "weak" attribute:
9060
c0065db7
RM
9061@example
9062void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 9063void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 9064@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9065
9066See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9067symbols.
9068
9069@item renaming symbols
9070Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 9071kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
9072@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9073DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 9074created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 9075
c0065db7 9076@example
dc8465bf
NC
9077LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9078
9079EXPORTS
9080_foo = foo
c0065db7 9081@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9082
9083The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9084@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 9085@end table
dc8465bf 9086
0a5d968e 9087Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 9088unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 9089If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
9090@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9091that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9092@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9093renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9094to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9095the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9096In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 9097which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
9098
9099@cindex weak externals
9100@item weak externals
9101The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9102weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9103defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9104are three variants of weak externals:
9105@itemize
9106@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9107called lazy externals.
9108@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9109This form is not presently implemented.
9110@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9111implemented.
9112@end itemize
9113As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9114are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9115uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
9116
9117@cindex aligned common symbols
9118@item aligned common symbols
9119As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9120desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9121the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9122carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9123by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9124tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9125but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9126warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 9127
2ca22b03
NC
9128@end table
9129
9130@ifclear GENERIC
9131@lowersections
9132@end ifclear
9133@end ifset
9134
e0001a05
NC
9135@ifset XTENSA
9136@ifclear GENERIC
9137@raisesections
9138@end ifclear
9139
9140@node Xtensa
9141@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9142
9143@cindex Xtensa processors
9144The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9145@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9146specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9147keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9148example, with the command:
9149
9150@smallexample
9151SECTIONS
9152@{
9153 .text : @{
9154 *(.literal .text)
9155 @}
9156@}
9157@end smallexample
9158
9159@noindent
9160@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9161and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9162literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9163interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9164group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9165files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9166and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 9167
43cd72b9 9168@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 9169@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
9170Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9171provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9172is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9173literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9174will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9175location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9176the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9177unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9178@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9179range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9180
9181For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9182to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9183instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9184instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9185instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9186@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9187hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9188By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9189switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9190density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9191instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9192performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9193linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9194a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9195
9196The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9197control the linker:
9198
9199@cindex Xtensa options
9200@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
9201@item --size-opt
9202When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9203more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9204no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9205alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9206preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
9207
9208@item --abi-windowed
9209@itemx --abi-call0
9210Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9211PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9212because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9213conventions.
9214Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9215of the first input object.
9216A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9217or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 9218@end table
e0001a05
NC
9219
9220@ifclear GENERIC
9221@lowersections
9222@end ifclear
9223@end ifset
9224
252b5132
RH
9225@ifclear SingleFormat
9226@node BFD
9227@chapter BFD
9228
9229@cindex back end
9230@cindex object file management
9231@cindex object formats available
9232@kindex objdump -i
9233The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9234These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9235object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9236format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9237it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9238associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9239object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9240(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9241list all the formats available for your configuration.
9242
9243@cindex BFD requirements
9244@cindex requirements for BFD
9245As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9246several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9247BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9248formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9249been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9250BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9251may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9252
9253One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9254mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9255useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9256conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9257
9258@menu
9259* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9260@end menu
9261
9262@node BFD outline
36f63dca 9263@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
9264@cindex opening object files
9265@include bfdsumm.texi
9266@end ifclear
9267
9268@node Reporting Bugs
9269@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
9270@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9271@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 9272
ff5dcc92 9273Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
9274
9275Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9276it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 9277to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 9278work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 9279@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9280
9281In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9282information that enables us to fix the bug.
9283
9284@menu
9285* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9286* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9287@end menu
9288
9289@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 9290@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
9291@cindex bug criteria
9292
9293If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9294
9295@itemize @bullet
9296@cindex fatal signal
9297@cindex linker crash
9298@cindex crash of linker
9299@item
9300If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9301@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9302
9303@cindex error on valid input
9304@item
ff5dcc92 9305If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9306
9307@cindex invalid input
9308@item
ff5dcc92 9309If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9310may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9311object files are correct.
9312
9313@item
9314If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9315improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9316@end itemize
9317
9318@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9319@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9320@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9321@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9322
9323A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9324products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9325recommend you contact that organization first.
9326
9327You can find contact information for many support companies and
9328individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9329distribution.
9330
ad22bfe8 9331@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9332Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9333@value{BUGURL}.
9334@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9335
9336The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9337@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9338fact or leave it out, state it!
9339
9340Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9341problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9342assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9343matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9344the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9345location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9346were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9347into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9348specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9349and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9350
9351Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9352the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9353on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9354
9355Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9356bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9357respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9358You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9359
9360To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9361
9362@itemize @bullet
9363@item
ff5dcc92 9364The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9365the @samp{--version} argument.
9366
9367Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9368the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9369
9370@item
ff5dcc92 9371Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9372patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9373
9374@item
9375The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9376version number.
9377
9378@item
ff5dcc92 9379What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9380``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9381
9382@item
9383The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9384observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9385list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9386sufficient.
9387
9388If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9389and then we might not encounter the bug.
9390
9391@item
9392A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9393bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9394provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9395bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9396state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9397requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9398we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9399attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9400
9401If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9402@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9403object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9404@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9405how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9406
9407@item
9408A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9409incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9410
ff5dcc92 9411Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9412will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9413not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9414a chance to make a mistake.
9415
9416Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9417say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9418copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9419C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9420and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9421fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9422you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9423any conclusion from our observations.
9424
9425@item
ff5dcc92 9426If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9427diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9428@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9429If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9430context, not by line number.
9431
9432The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9433sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9434@end itemize
9435
9436Here are some things that are not necessary:
9437
9438@itemize @bullet
9439@item
9440A description of the envelope of the bug.
9441
9442Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9443which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9444changes will not affect it.
9445
9446This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9447will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9448with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9449We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9450
9451Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9452of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9453output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9454less time, and so on.
9455
9456However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9457report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9458
9459@item
9460A patch for the bug.
9461
9462A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9463the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9464a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9465to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9466
ff5dcc92 9467Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9468construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9469through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9470able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9471fixed.
9472
9473And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9474patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9475help us to understand.
9476
9477@item
9478A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9479
9480Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9481things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9482@end itemize
9483
9484@node MRI
9485@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9486@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9487To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9488linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9489alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9490described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9491simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9492@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9493linker commands; these commands are described here.
9494
9495In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9496file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9497features to make use of them.
9498
9499You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9500@samp{-c} command-line option.
9501
9502Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9503command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9504blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9505MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9506issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9507
9508Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9509
9510You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9511lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9512The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9513
9514@table @code
9515@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9516@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9517@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9518Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9519the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9520@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9521your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9522script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9523commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9524input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9525@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9526
9527@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9528@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9529Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9530in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9531
9532@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9533
9534@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9535@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9536Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9537@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9538
9539@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9540@item BASE @var{expression}
9541Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9542absolute addresses) in the output file.
9543
9544@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9545@item CHIP @var{expression}
9546@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9547This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9548
9549@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9550@item END
9551This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9552
9553@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9554@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9555Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9556language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9557
9558@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9559@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9560Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9561@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9562
9563The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9564same line, with no change in its effect.
9565
9566@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9567@item LOAD @var{filename}
9568@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9569Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9570same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9571command line.
9572
9573@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9574@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9575@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9576MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9577option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9578
9579@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9580@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9581@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9582Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9583order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9584script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9585sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9586file, in the order specified.
9587
9588@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9589@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9590@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9591@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9592Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9593@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9594
9595@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9596@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9597@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9598@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9599You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9600specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9601If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9602@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9603@end table
9604
793c5807
NC
9605@node GNU Free Documentation License
9606@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9607@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9608
370b66a1
CD
9609@node LD Index
9610@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9611
9612@printindex cp
9613
9614@tex
7ca01ed9 9615% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9616% meantime:
9617\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9618\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9619\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9620\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9621\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9622\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9623\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9624\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9625\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9626% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9627@end tex
9628
252b5132 9629@bye